GTK version
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
135 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
138 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
139 #ifndef XtNpickTop
140 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
141 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
142 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
143 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144
145 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146
147 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
148 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #endif
151
152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
153 #include "widget.h"
154 #ifndef XtNinitialState
155 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
156 #endif
157 #endif
158
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160
161 #define BETWEEN(X, LOWER, UPPER) ((X) >= (LOWER) && (X) < (UPPER))
162
163 \f
164 /* Fringe bitmaps. */
165
166 enum fringe_bitmap_type
167 {
168 NO_FRINGE_BITMAP,
169 LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
170 RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
171 OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP,
172 CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP,
173 CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP,
174 ZV_LINE_BITMAP
175 };
176
177 /* Bitmap drawn to indicate lines not displaying text if
178 `indicate-empty-lines' is non-nil. */
179
180 #define zv_width 8
181 #define zv_height 72
182 #define zv_period 3
183 static unsigned char zv_bits[] = {
184 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
185 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
186 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
187 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
188 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
189 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
190 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
191 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00};
192
193 /* An arrow like this: `<-'. */
194
195 #define left_width 8
196 #define left_height 8
197 static unsigned char left_bits[] = {
198 0x18, 0x0c, 0x06, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x06, 0x0c, 0x18};
199
200 /* Right truncation arrow bitmap `->'. */
201
202 #define right_width 8
203 #define right_height 8
204 static unsigned char right_bits[] = {
205 0x18, 0x30, 0x60, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0x60, 0x30, 0x18};
206
207 /* Marker for continued lines. */
208
209 #define continued_width 8
210 #define continued_height 8
211 static unsigned char continued_bits[] = {
212 0x3c, 0x7c, 0xc0, 0xe4, 0xfc, 0x7c, 0x3c, 0x7c};
213
214 /* Marker for continuation lines. */
215
216 #define continuation_width 8
217 #define continuation_height 8
218 static unsigned char continuation_bits[] = {
219 0x3c, 0x3e, 0x03, 0x27, 0x3f, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x3e};
220
221 /* Overlay arrow bitmap. */
222
223 #if 0
224 /* A bomb. */
225 #define ov_width 8
226 #define ov_height 8
227 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
228 0x30, 0x08, 0x3c, 0x7e, 0x7a, 0x7a, 0x62, 0x3c};
229 #else
230 /* A triangular arrow. */
231 #define ov_width 8
232 #define ov_height 8
233 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
234 0x03, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x1f, 0x0f, 0x03};
235
236 #endif
237
238 extern Lisp_Object Qhelp_echo;
239
240 \f
241 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
242
243 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
244
245 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
246 (The display is done in read_char.) */
247
248 static Lisp_Object help_echo;
249 static Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
250 static Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
251 static int help_echo_pos;
252
253 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
254
255 static Lisp_Object previous_help_echo;
256
257 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
258 start. */
259
260 static int any_help_event_p;
261
262 /* Non-zero means autoselect window with the mouse cursor. */
263
264 int mouse_autoselect_window;
265
266 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
267 static Lisp_Object last_window;
268
269 /* Non-zero means draw block and hollow cursor as wide as the glyph
270 under it. For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be
271 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. */
272
273 int x_stretch_cursor_p;
274
275 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
276
277 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
278
279 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
280 use. */
281
282 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
283
284 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
285 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
286 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
287 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
288
289 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
290
291 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
292 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
293 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
294 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
295
296 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
297
298 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
299
300 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
301
302 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
303 /* The application context for Xt use. */
304 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
305 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
306 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
307
308 /* Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
309 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
310 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
311
312 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
313
314 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
315
316 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
317
318 /* Mouse movement.
319
320 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
321 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
322 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
323 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
324
325 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
326
327 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
328 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
329 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
330 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
331 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
332 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
333 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
334 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
335 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
336 is off. */
337
338 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
339
340 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
341 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
342 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
343
344 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
345
346 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
347 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
348 an ordinary motion.
349
350 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
351 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
352 event. */
353
354 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
355
356 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
357 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
358 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
359 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
360 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
361 it's somewhat accurate. */
362
363 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
364
365 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
366 events. */
367
368 #ifdef __STDC__
369 static int volatile input_signal_count;
370 #else
371 static int input_signal_count;
372 #endif
373
374 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
375
376 static int x_noop_count;
377
378 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
379
380 extern char **initial_argv;
381 extern int initial_argc;
382
383 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
384
385 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
386
387 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
388
389 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face, Qeql;
390
391 extern int errno;
392
393 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
394
395 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
396
397 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
398
399 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
400 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
401 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
402
403 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
404 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1, Qutf_8;
405
406 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
407 extern Lisp_Object x_icon_type P_ ((struct frame *));
408
409
410 /* Enumeration for overriding/changing the face to use for drawing
411 glyphs in x_draw_glyphs. */
412
413 enum draw_glyphs_face
414 {
415 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
416 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO,
417 DRAW_CURSOR,
418 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE,
419 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED,
420 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
421 };
422
423 static int cursor_in_mouse_face_p P_ ((struct window *));
424 static int clear_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
425 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
426 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
427 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
428 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
429 static void frame_to_window_pixel_xy P_ ((struct window *, int *, int *));
430 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
431 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
432 unsigned));
433 static int fast_find_position P_ ((struct window *, int, int *, int *,
434 int *, int *, Lisp_Object));
435 static int fast_find_string_pos P_ ((struct window *, int, Lisp_Object,
436 int *, int *, int *, int *, int));
437 static void set_output_cursor P_ ((struct cursor_pos *));
438 static struct glyph *x_y_to_hpos_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int, int,
439 int *, int *, int *, int));
440 static void note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight P_ ((struct window *, int,
441 int, int));
442 static void note_mouse_highlight P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
443 static void note_tool_bar_highlight P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int));
444 static void x_handle_tool_bar_click P_ ((struct frame *, XButtonEvent *));
445 static void show_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
446 enum draw_glyphs_face));
447 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
448 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
449 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
450 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
451 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
452 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
453 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
454 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
455 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
456 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
457 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
458 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
459 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
460 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
461 static void x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph P_ ((struct window *,
462 struct glyph_row *,
463 enum draw_glyphs_face));
464 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
465 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
466 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
467 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
468 static void XTcursor_to P_ ((int, int, int, int));
469 static void x_write_glyphs P_ ((struct glyph *, int));
470 static void x_clear_end_of_line P_ ((int));
471 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
472 static void x_clear_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
473 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
474 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
475 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
476 static int x_focus_changed P_ ((int,
477 int,
478 struct x_display_info *,
479 struct frame *,
480 struct input_event *,
481 int));
482 static int x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
483 XEvent *,
484 struct input_event *,
485 int));
486 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
487 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
488 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
489 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
490 enum text_cursor_kinds));
491 static int x_intersect_rectangles P_ ((XRectangle *, XRectangle *,
492 XRectangle *));
493 static void expose_frame P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int));
494 static int expose_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
495 static void expose_overlaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
496 struct glyph_row *));
497 static int expose_window P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
498 static void expose_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
499 XRectangle *, enum glyph_row_area));
500 static int expose_line P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
501 XRectangle *));
502 static void x_update_cursor_in_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int));
503 static void x_update_window_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int));
504 static void x_erase_phys_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
505 void x_display_and_set_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int, int, int));
506 static void x_draw_fringe_bitmap P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
507 enum fringe_bitmap_type, int left_p));
508
509 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
510 GC, int));
511 static int x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
512 static void x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
513 static void notice_overwritten_cursor P_ ((struct window *, enum glyph_row_area,
514 int, int, int, int));
515 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
516 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
517 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
518 static void x_draw_vertical_border P_ ((struct window *));
519 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
520 static INLINE void take_vertical_position_into_account P_ ((struct it *));
521 static void x_produce_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
522 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
523 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
524 enum scroll_bar_part *,
525 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
526 unsigned long *));
527 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
528 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
529 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
530 XEvent *,
531 struct input_event **,
532 int *,
533 int *));
534
535
536 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
537
538 static void
539 x_flush (f)
540 struct frame *f;
541 {
542 BLOCK_INPUT;
543 if (f == NULL)
544 {
545 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
546 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
547 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
548 }
549 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
550 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
551 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
552 }
553
554
555 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
556 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
557 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
558 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
559 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
560 performance. */
561
562 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
563
564 \f
565 /***********************************************************************
566 Debugging
567 ***********************************************************************/
568
569 #if 0
570
571 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
572 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
573
574 struct record
575 {
576 char *locus;
577 int type;
578 };
579
580 struct record event_record[100];
581
582 int event_record_index;
583
584 record_event (locus, type)
585 char *locus;
586 int type;
587 {
588 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
589 event_record_index = 0;
590
591 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
592 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
593 event_record_index++;
594 }
595
596 #endif /* 0 */
597
598
599 \f
600 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
601
602 struct x_display_info *
603 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
604 Display *dpy;
605 {
606 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
607
608 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
609 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
610 return dpyinfo;
611
612 return 0;
613 }
614
615
616 \f
617 /***********************************************************************
618 Starting and ending an update
619 ***********************************************************************/
620
621 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
622 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
623 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
624 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
625 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
626
627 static void
628 x_update_begin (f)
629 struct frame *f;
630 {
631 /* Nothing to do. */
632 }
633
634
635 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
636 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
637 position of W. */
638
639 static void
640 x_update_window_begin (w)
641 struct window *w;
642 {
643 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
644 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
645
646 updated_window = w;
647 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
648
649 BLOCK_INPUT;
650
651 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
652 {
653 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
654 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
655
656 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
657 highlighting. */
658 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
659 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
660
661 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
662 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
663 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
664 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
665 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
666 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
667
668 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
669 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
670 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
671 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
672 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
673 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
674 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
675 {
676 int i;
677
678 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
679 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
680 break;
681
682 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
683 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
684 }
685 #endif /* 0 */
686 }
687
688 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
689 }
690
691
692 /* Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
693 have vertical scroll bars. */
694
695 static void
696 x_draw_vertical_border (w)
697 struct window *w;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700
701 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
702 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
703 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
704 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
705 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
706 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
707 {
708 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
709
710 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
711 x1 += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
712 y1 -= 1;
713
714 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x1, y0, x1, y1);
716 }
717 }
718
719
720 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
721
722 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
723 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
724
725 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
726 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
727 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
728
729 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
730 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
731 here. */
732
733 static void
734 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
735 struct window *w;
736 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
737 {
738 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
739
740 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
741 {
742 BLOCK_INPUT;
743
744 if (cursor_on_p)
745 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
746 output_cursor.vpos,
747 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
748
749 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
750 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
751 }
752
753 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
754 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
755 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
756 {
757 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
758 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
759 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
760 }
761
762 updated_window = NULL;
763 }
764
765
766 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
767 update_end. */
768
769 static void
770 x_update_end (f)
771 struct frame *f;
772 {
773 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
774 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
775
776 BLOCK_INPUT;
777 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
778 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
779 }
780
781
782 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
783 complete update has been performed. The global variable
784 updated_window is not available here. */
785
786 static void
787 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
788 struct frame *f;
789 {
790 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
791 {
792 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
793
794 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
795 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
796 {
797 BLOCK_INPUT;
798 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
799 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
800 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
801 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
802 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
803 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
804 }
805 }
806 }
807
808
809 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
810 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
811 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
812 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
813 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
814 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
815
816 static void
817 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
818 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
819 {
820 struct window *w = updated_window;
821 struct frame *f;
822 int width, height;
823
824 xassert (w);
825
826 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
827 {
828 BLOCK_INPUT;
829 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
830 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
831 }
832
833 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
834 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
835 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
836 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
837 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
838 overhead is very small. */
839 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
840 && desired_row->full_width_p
841 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
842 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
843 width != 0)
844 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
845 height > 0))
846 {
847 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
848
849 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
850 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
851 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
852 y -= width;
853
854 BLOCK_INPUT;
855 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
856 0, y, width, height, False);
857 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
858 f->output_data.x->pixel_width - width,
859 y, width, height, False);
860 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
861 }
862 }
863
864
865 /* Draw the bitmap WHICH in one of the left or right fringes of
866 window W. ROW is the glyph row for which to display the bitmap; it
867 determines the vertical position at which the bitmap has to be
868 drawn. */
869
870 static void
871 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, which, left_p)
872 struct window *w;
873 struct glyph_row *row;
874 enum fringe_bitmap_type which;
875 int left_p;
876 {
877 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
878 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
879 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
880 int x, y, wd, h, dy;
881 int b1, b2;
882 unsigned char *bits = NULL;
883 Pixmap pixmap;
884 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
885 struct face *face;
886 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
887
888 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
889 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 1);
890
891 /* Convert row to frame coordinates. */
892 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
893
894 switch (which)
895 {
896 case NO_FRINGE_BITMAP:
897 wd = 0;
898 h = 0;
899 break;
900
901 case LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
902 wd = left_width;
903 h = left_height;
904 bits = left_bits;
905 break;
906
907 case OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP:
908 wd = ov_width;
909 h = ov_height;
910 bits = ov_bits;
911 break;
912
913 case RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
914 wd = right_width;
915 h = right_height;
916 bits = right_bits;
917 break;
918
919 case CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP:
920 wd = continued_width;
921 h = continued_height;
922 bits = continued_bits;
923 break;
924
925 case CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP:
926 wd = continuation_width;
927 h = continuation_height;
928 bits = continuation_bits;
929 break;
930
931 case ZV_LINE_BITMAP:
932 wd = zv_width;
933 h = zv_height - (y % zv_period);
934 bits = zv_bits + (y % zv_period);
935 break;
936
937 default:
938 abort ();
939 }
940
941 /* Clip bitmap if too high. */
942 if (h > row->height)
943 h = row->height;
944
945 /* Set dy to the offset in the row to start drawing the bitmap. */
946 dy = (row->height - h) / 2;
947
948 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, FRINGE_FACE_ID);
949 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
950
951 /* Clear left fringe if no bitmap to draw or if bitmap doesn't fill
952 the fringe. */
953 b1 = b2 = -1;
954 if (left_p)
955 {
956 if (wd > FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
957 wd = FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
958 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
959 - wd
960 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
961 if (wd < FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
962 {
963 /* If W has a vertical border to its left, don't draw over it. */
964 int border = ((XFASTINT (w->left) > 0
965 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
966 ? 1 : 0);
967 b1 = (window_box_left (w, -1)
968 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f)
969 + border);
970 b2 = (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - border);
971 }
972 }
973 else
974 {
975 if (wd > FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
976 wd = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
977 x = (window_box_right (w, -1)
978 + (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
979 /* Clear right fringe if no bitmap to draw of if bitmap doesn't fill
980 the fringe. */
981 if (wd < FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
982 {
983 b1 = window_box_right (w, -1);
984 b2 = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
985 }
986 }
987
988 if (b1 >= 0)
989 {
990 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
991
992 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
993 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
994 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
995 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
996 if (face->stipple)
997 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
998 else
999 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
1000
1001 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
1002 b1,
1003 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1004 row->y)),
1005 b2,
1006 row->visible_height);
1007 if (!face->stipple)
1008 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
1009 }
1010
1011 if (which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
1012 {
1013 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
1014 by the server. */
1015 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, wd, h,
1016 face->foreground,
1017 face->background, depth);
1018 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0, wd, h, x, y + dy);
1019 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
1020 }
1021
1022 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
1023 }
1024
1025
1026 /* Draw fringe bitmaps for glyph row ROW on window W. Call this
1027 function with input blocked. */
1028
1029 static void
1030 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row)
1031 struct window *w;
1032 struct glyph_row *row;
1033 {
1034 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1035 enum fringe_bitmap_type bitmap;
1036
1037 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
1038
1039 /* If row is completely invisible, because of vscrolling, we
1040 don't have to draw anything. */
1041 if (row->visible_height <= 0)
1042 return;
1043
1044 if (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1045 {
1046 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the left fringe. */
1047 if (row->overlay_arrow_p)
1048 bitmap = OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP;
1049 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p)
1050 bitmap = LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1051 else if (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
1052 bitmap = CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP;
1053 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p)
1054 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1055 else
1056 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1057
1058 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 1);
1059 }
1060
1061 if (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1062 {
1063 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the right fringe. */
1064 if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
1065 bitmap = RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1066 else if (row->continued_p)
1067 bitmap = CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP;
1068 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p && FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) == 0)
1069 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1070 else
1071 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1072
1073 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 0);
1074 }
1075 }
1076
1077 \f
1078
1079 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
1080 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
1081 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
1082 rarely happens). */
1083
1084 static void
1085 XTset_terminal_modes ()
1086 {
1087 }
1088
1089 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
1090 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
1091
1092 static void
1093 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
1094 {
1095 }
1096
1097
1098 \f
1099 /***********************************************************************
1100 Output Cursor
1101 ***********************************************************************/
1102
1103 /* Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
1104 positions are relative to updated_window. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 set_output_cursor (cursor)
1108 struct cursor_pos *cursor;
1109 {
1110 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
1111 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
1112 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
1113 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set a nominal cursor position.
1118
1119 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
1120 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
1121
1122 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
1123 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
1124 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
1125 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
1126
1127 static void
1128 XTcursor_to (vpos, hpos, y, x)
1129 int vpos, hpos, y, x;
1130 {
1131 struct window *w;
1132
1133 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
1134 if (updated_window)
1135 w = updated_window;
1136 else
1137 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1138
1139 /* Set the output cursor. */
1140 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
1141 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
1142 output_cursor.x = x;
1143 output_cursor.y = y;
1144
1145 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
1146 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
1147 if (updated_window == NULL)
1148 {
1149 BLOCK_INPUT;
1150 x_display_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
1151 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (SELECTED_FRAME ()));
1152 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1153 }
1154 }
1155
1156
1157 \f
1158 /***********************************************************************
1159 Display Iterator
1160 ***********************************************************************/
1161
1162 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
1163
1164 static struct face *x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *,
1165 struct glyph *,
1166 XChar2b *,
1167 int *));
1168 static struct face *x_get_char_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *, int,
1169 int, XChar2b *, int,
1170 int));
1171 static XCharStruct *x_per_char_metric P_ ((XFontStruct *, XChar2b *));
1172 static void x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *));
1173 static void x_append_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1174 static void x_append_composite_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1175 static void x_append_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *it, Lisp_Object,
1176 int, int, double));
1177 static void x_produce_glyphs P_ ((struct it *));
1178 static void x_produce_image_glyph P_ ((struct it *it));
1179
1180
1181 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
1182 is not contained in the font. */
1183
1184 static INLINE XCharStruct *
1185 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b)
1186 XFontStruct *font;
1187 XChar2b *char2b;
1188 {
1189 /* The result metric information. */
1190 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
1191
1192 xassert (font && char2b);
1193
1194 if (font->per_char != NULL)
1195 {
1196 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
1197 {
1198 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
1199 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
1200 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
1201 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
1202 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
1203 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
1204 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
1205 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1206 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1207 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
1208 }
1209 else
1210 {
1211 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
1212 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
1213 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
1214 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
1215
1216 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
1217 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
1218
1219 where:
1220
1221 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
1222 / = integer division
1223 \ = integer modulus */
1224 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
1225 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
1226 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1227 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1228 {
1229 pcm = (font->per_char
1230 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
1231 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
1232 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
1233 }
1234 }
1235 }
1236 else
1237 {
1238 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
1239 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
1240 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
1241 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1242 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1243 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
1244 }
1245
1246 return ((pcm == NULL
1247 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
1248 ? NULL : pcm);
1249 }
1250
1251
1252 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
1253 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
1254
1255 static INLINE void
1256 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info)
1257 int c;
1258 XChar2b *char2b;
1259 struct font_info *font_info;
1260 {
1261 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
1262 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
1263
1264 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
1265 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
1266 fixed encoding. */
1267 if (font_info->font_encoder)
1268 {
1269 /* It's a program. */
1270 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
1271
1272 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
1273 {
1274 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1275 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
1276 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
1277 }
1278 else
1279 {
1280 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1281 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
1282 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
1283 }
1284
1285 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
1286
1287 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
1288 program. */
1289 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
1290 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
1291 else
1292 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
1293 }
1294 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
1295 {
1296 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1297 encoding numbers. */
1298 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
1299
1300 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1301 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1302 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1303
1304 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1305 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1306 }
1307 }
1308
1309
1310 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame
1311 F. The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1312 means we want to display multibyte text. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
1313 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
1314 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
1315 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
1316
1317 static INLINE struct face *
1318 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (f, c, face_id, char2b, multibyte_p, display_p)
1319 struct frame *f;
1320 int c, face_id;
1321 XChar2b *char2b;
1322 int multibyte_p, display_p;
1323 {
1324 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1325
1326 if (!multibyte_p)
1327 {
1328 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1329 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1330 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1331 char2b->byte2 = c;
1332 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, c);
1333 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1334 }
1335 else if (c < 128 && face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1336 {
1337 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1338 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1339 char2b->byte2 = c;
1340 }
1341 else
1342 {
1343 int c1, c2, charset;
1344
1345 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1346 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1347 SPLIT_CHAR (c, charset, c1, c2);
1348 if (c2 > 0)
1349 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1350 else
1351 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1352
1353 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1354 if (face->font != NULL)
1355 {
1356 struct font_info *font_info
1357 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1358 if (font_info)
1359 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info);
1360 }
1361 }
1362
1363 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1364 if (display_p)
1365 {
1366 xassert (face != NULL);
1367 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1368 }
1369
1370 return face;
1371 }
1372
1373
1374 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
1375 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
1376 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
1377
1378 static INLINE struct face *
1379 x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, char2b, two_byte_p)
1380 struct frame *f;
1381 struct glyph *glyph;
1382 XChar2b *char2b;
1383 int *two_byte_p;
1384 {
1385 struct face *face;
1386
1387 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
1388 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
1389
1390 if (two_byte_p)
1391 *two_byte_p = 0;
1392
1393 if (!glyph->multibyte_p)
1394 {
1395 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1396 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1397 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1398 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1399 }
1400 else if (glyph->u.ch < 128
1401 && glyph->face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1402 {
1403 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1404 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1405 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1406 }
1407 else
1408 {
1409 int c1, c2, charset;
1410
1411 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1412 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1413 SPLIT_CHAR (glyph->u.ch, charset, c1, c2);
1414 if (c2 > 0)
1415 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1416 else
1417 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1418
1419 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1420 if (charset != CHARSET_ASCII)
1421 {
1422 struct font_info *font_info
1423 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1424 if (font_info)
1425 {
1426 x_encode_char (glyph->u.ch, char2b, font_info);
1427 if (two_byte_p)
1428 *two_byte_p
1429 = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1430 }
1431 }
1432 }
1433
1434 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1435 xassert (face != NULL);
1436 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1437 return face;
1438 }
1439
1440
1441 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
1442 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1443
1444 static INLINE void
1445 x_append_glyph (it)
1446 struct it *it;
1447 {
1448 struct glyph *glyph;
1449 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1450
1451 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1452 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
1453
1454 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1455 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1456 {
1457 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1458 glyph->object = it->object;
1459 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1460 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1461 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
1462 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1463 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1464 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1465 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1466 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1467 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1468 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
1469 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1470 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
1471 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1472 }
1473 }
1474
1475 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_id in IT->glyph_row.
1476 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1477
1478 static INLINE void
1479 x_append_composite_glyph (it)
1480 struct it *it;
1481 {
1482 struct glyph *glyph;
1483 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1484
1485 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1486
1487 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1488 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1489 {
1490 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1491 glyph->object = it->object;
1492 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1493 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1494 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
1495 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1496 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1497 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1498 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1499 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1500 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1501 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1502 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1503 glyph->u.cmp_id = it->cmp_id;
1504 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1505 }
1506 }
1507
1508
1509 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
1510 IT->voffset. */
1511
1512 static INLINE void
1513 take_vertical_position_into_account (it)
1514 struct it *it;
1515 {
1516 if (it->voffset)
1517 {
1518 if (it->voffset < 0)
1519 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
1520 in the line. */
1521 it->ascent += abs (it->voffset);
1522 else
1523 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
1524 in the line. */
1525 it->descent += it->voffset;
1526 }
1527 }
1528
1529
1530 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
1531 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
1532 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1533
1534 static void
1535 x_produce_image_glyph (it)
1536 struct it *it;
1537 {
1538 struct image *img;
1539 struct face *face;
1540
1541 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
1542
1543 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1544 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
1545 xassert (img);
1546
1547 /* Make sure X resources of the face and image are loaded. */
1548 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1549 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
1550
1551 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = image_ascent (img, face);
1552 it->descent = it->phys_descent = img->height + 2 * img->vmargin - it->ascent;
1553 it->pixel_width = img->width + 2 * img->hmargin;
1554
1555 it->nglyphs = 1;
1556
1557 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1558 {
1559 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1560 {
1561 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1562 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1563 }
1564
1565 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1566 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1567 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1568 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1569 }
1570
1571 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1572
1573 if (it->glyph_row)
1574 {
1575 struct glyph *glyph;
1576 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1577
1578 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1579 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1580 {
1581 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1582 glyph->object = it->object;
1583 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1584 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1585 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
1586 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1587 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1588 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1589 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1590 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1591 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1592 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1593 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
1594 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1595 }
1596 }
1597 }
1598
1599
1600 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
1601 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
1602 stretch. ASCENT is the percentage/100 of HEIGHT to use for the
1603 ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= 1). */
1604
1605 static void
1606 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent)
1607 struct it *it;
1608 Lisp_Object object;
1609 int width, height;
1610 double ascent;
1611 {
1612 struct glyph *glyph;
1613 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1614
1615 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= 1);
1616
1617 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1618 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1619 {
1620 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1621 glyph->object = object;
1622 glyph->pixel_width = width;
1623 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1624 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
1625 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1626 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1627 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1628 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1629 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1630 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1631 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1632 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = height * ascent;
1633 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
1634 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1635 }
1636 }
1637
1638
1639 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
1640 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
1641 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
1642 being recognized:
1643
1644 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
1645 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
1646 point number.
1647
1648 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
1649 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
1650 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
1651
1652 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
1653 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
1654
1655 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
1656
1657 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
1658 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
1659
1660 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
1661 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
1662 the glyph property.
1663
1664 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
1665
1666 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
1667 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
1668 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
1669
1670 #define NUMVAL(X) \
1671 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
1672 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
1673 : - 1)
1674
1675
1676 static void
1677 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it)
1678 struct it *it;
1679 {
1680 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT. */
1681 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1682 extern Lisp_Object Qspace;
1683 #endif
1684 extern Lisp_Object QCwidth, QCheight, QCascent;
1685 extern Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
1686 extern Lisp_Object QCalign_to;
1687 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
1688 double width = 0, height = 0, ascent = 0;
1689 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1690 XFontStruct *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1691
1692 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1693
1694 /* List should start with `space'. */
1695 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
1696 plist = XCDR (it->object);
1697
1698 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
1699 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth),
1700 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1701 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
1702 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1703 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width),
1704 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1705 {
1706 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
1707 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
1708 property. */
1709 struct it it2;
1710 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1711
1712 it2 = *it;
1713 if (it->multibyte_p)
1714 {
1715 int maxlen = ((IT_BYTEPOS (*it) >= GPT ? ZV : GPT)
1716 - IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1717 it2.c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, maxlen, it2.len);
1718 }
1719 else
1720 it2.c = *p, it2.len = 1;
1721
1722 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
1723 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
1724 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
1725 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
1726 }
1727 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to),
1728 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1729 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f) - it->current_x;
1730 else
1731 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
1732 width = CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1733
1734 /* Compute height. */
1735 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight),
1736 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1737 height = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_Y_UNIT (it->f);
1738 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
1739 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1740 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
1741 else
1742 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1743
1744 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
1745 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
1746 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
1747 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
1748 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
1749 ascent = NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
1750 else
1751 ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1752
1753 if (width <= 0)
1754 width = 1;
1755 if (height <= 0)
1756 height = 1;
1757
1758 if (it->glyph_row)
1759 {
1760 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
1761 if (!STRINGP (object))
1762 object = it->w->buffer;
1763 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
1764 }
1765
1766 it->pixel_width = width;
1767 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = height * ascent;
1768 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
1769 it->nglyphs = 1;
1770
1771 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1772 {
1773 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1774 {
1775 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1776 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1777 }
1778
1779 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1780 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1781 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1782 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1783 }
1784
1785 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1786 }
1787
1788 /* Return proper value to be used as baseline offset of font that has
1789 ASCENT and DESCENT to draw characters by the font at the vertical
1790 center of the line of frame F.
1791
1792 Here, out task is to find the value of BOFF in the following figure;
1793
1794 -------------------------+-----------+-
1795 -+-+---------+-+ | |
1796 | | | | | |
1797 | | | | F_ASCENT F_HEIGHT
1798 | | | ASCENT | |
1799 HEIGHT | | | | |
1800 | | |-|-+------+-----------|------- baseline
1801 | | | | BOFF | |
1802 | |---------|-+-+ | |
1803 | | | DESCENT | |
1804 -+-+---------+-+ F_DESCENT |
1805 -------------------------+-----------+-
1806
1807 -BOFF + DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 = F_DESCENT
1808 BOFF = DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 - F_DESCENT
1809 DESCENT = FONT->descent
1810 HEIGHT = FONT_HEIGHT (FONT)
1811 F_DESCENT = (F->output_data.x->font->descent
1812 - F->output_data.x->baseline_offset)
1813 F_HEIGHT = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (F)
1814 */
1815
1816 #define VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET(FONT, F) \
1817 ((FONT)->descent \
1818 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) - FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)) \
1819 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) > FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)))) / 2 \
1820 - ((F)->output_data.x->font->descent - (F)->output_data.x->baseline_offset))
1821
1822 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
1823 loaded with. See the description of struct display_iterator in
1824 dispextern.h for an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1825
1826 static void
1827 x_produce_glyphs (it)
1828 struct it *it;
1829 {
1830 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1831
1832 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
1833 {
1834 XChar2b char2b;
1835 XFontStruct *font;
1836 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1837 XCharStruct *pcm;
1838 int font_not_found_p;
1839 struct font_info *font_info;
1840 int boff; /* baseline offset */
1841 /* We may change it->multibyte_p upon unibyte<->multibyte
1842 conversion. So, save the current value now and restore it
1843 later.
1844
1845 Note: It seems that we don't have to record multibyte_p in
1846 struct glyph because the character code itself tells if or
1847 not the character is multibyte. Thus, in the future, we must
1848 consider eliminating the field `multibyte_p' in the struct
1849 glyph. */
1850 int saved_multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1851
1852 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte, or the
1853 other way. */
1854 it->char_to_display = it->c;
1855 if (!ASCII_BYTE_P (it->c))
1856 {
1857 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
1858 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1859 && (it->c >= 0240
1860 || !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table)))
1861 {
1862 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
1863 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1864 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1865 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1866 }
1867 else if (!SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1868 && !it->multibyte_p)
1869 {
1870 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1871 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1872 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1873 }
1874 }
1875
1876 /* Get font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
1877 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
1878 it->face_id, &char2b,
1879 it->multibyte_p, 0);
1880 font = face->font;
1881
1882 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
1883 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
1884 if (font_not_found_p)
1885 {
1886 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1887 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
1888 font_info = NULL;
1889 }
1890 else
1891 {
1892 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
1893 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
1894 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
1895 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
1896 }
1897
1898 if (it->char_to_display >= ' '
1899 && (!it->multibyte_p || it->char_to_display < 128))
1900 {
1901 /* Either unibyte or ASCII. */
1902 int stretched_p;
1903
1904 it->nglyphs = 1;
1905
1906 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
1907 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1908 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
1909
1910 if (pcm)
1911 {
1912 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
1913 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
1914 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
1915 }
1916 else
1917 {
1918 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
1919 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1920 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1921 it->pixel_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
1922 }
1923
1924 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
1925 `space-width' property, change its width. */
1926 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
1927 if (stretched_p)
1928 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
1929
1930 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
1931 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
1932 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
1933 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1934 {
1935 int thick = face->box_line_width;
1936
1937 if (thick > 0)
1938 {
1939 it->ascent += thick;
1940 it->descent += thick;
1941 }
1942 else
1943 thick = -thick;
1944
1945 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1946 it->pixel_width += thick;
1947 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1948 it->pixel_width += thick;
1949 }
1950
1951 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
1952 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
1953 if (face->overline_p)
1954 it->ascent += 2;
1955
1956 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1957
1958 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
1959 if (it->glyph_row)
1960 {
1961 if (stretched_p)
1962 {
1963 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
1964 into a stretch glyph. */
1965 double ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1966 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1967 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1968 }
1969 else
1970 x_append_glyph (it);
1971
1972 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
1973 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
1974 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
1975 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
1976 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
1977 }
1978 }
1979 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
1980 {
1981 /* A newline has no width but we need the height of the line. */
1982 it->pixel_width = 0;
1983 it->nglyphs = 0;
1984 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1985 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1986
1987 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1988 && face->box_line_width > 0)
1989 {
1990 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1991 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1992 }
1993 }
1994 else if (it->char_to_display == '\t')
1995 {
1996 int tab_width = it->tab_width * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1997 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
1998 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
1999
2000 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
2001 stop is less than a canonical character width, use the
2002 tab stop after that. */
2003 if (next_tab_x - x < CANON_X_UNIT (it->f))
2004 next_tab_x += tab_width;
2005
2006 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
2007 it->nglyphs = 1;
2008 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2009 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2010
2011 if (it->glyph_row)
2012 {
2013 double ascent = (double) it->ascent / (it->ascent + it->descent);
2014 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
2015 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
2016 }
2017 }
2018 else
2019 {
2020 /* A multi-byte character. Assume that the display width of the
2021 character is the width of the character multiplied by the
2022 width of the font. */
2023
2024 /* If we found a font, this font should give us the right
2025 metrics. If we didn't find a font, use the frame's
2026 default font and calculate the width of the character
2027 from the charset width; this is what old redisplay code
2028 did. */
2029 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2030 if (font_not_found_p || !pcm)
2031 {
2032 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (it->char_to_display);
2033
2034 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
2035 it->pixel_width = (FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (it->f))
2036 * CHARSET_WIDTH (charset));
2037 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2038 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2039 }
2040 else
2041 {
2042 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2043 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2044 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2045 if (it->glyph_row
2046 && (pcm->lbearing < 0
2047 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2048 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2049 }
2050 it->nglyphs = 1;
2051 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2052 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2053 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2054 {
2055 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2056
2057 if (thick > 0)
2058 {
2059 it->ascent += thick;
2060 it->descent += thick;
2061 }
2062 else
2063 thick = - thick;
2064
2065 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2066 it->pixel_width += thick;
2067 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2068 it->pixel_width += thick;
2069 }
2070
2071 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2072 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2073 if (face->overline_p)
2074 it->ascent += 2;
2075
2076 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2077
2078 if (it->glyph_row)
2079 x_append_glyph (it);
2080 }
2081 it->multibyte_p = saved_multibyte_p;
2082 }
2083 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
2084 {
2085 /* Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
2086 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs. */
2087 XChar2b char2b;
2088 XFontStruct *font;
2089 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2090 XCharStruct *pcm;
2091 int font_not_found_p;
2092 struct font_info *font_info;
2093 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2094 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_id];
2095
2096 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte. */
2097 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2098 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2099 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2100 && (it->c >= 0240
2101 || (it->c >= 0200
2102 && !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table))))
2103 {
2104 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2105 }
2106
2107 /* Get face and font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2108 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2109 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2110 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2111 it->face_id, &char2b, it->multibyte_p, 0);
2112 font = face->font;
2113
2114 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2115 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2116 if (font_not_found_p)
2117 {
2118 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2119 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2120 font_info = NULL;
2121 }
2122 else
2123 {
2124 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2125 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2126 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2127 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2128 }
2129
2130 /* There are no padding glyphs, so there is only one glyph to
2131 produce for the composition. Important is that pixel_width,
2132 ascent and descent are the values of what is drawn by
2133 draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of the overall glyphs composed). */
2134 it->nglyphs = 1;
2135
2136 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
2137 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
2138 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
2139 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
2140 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This leads
2141 to incorrect display very rarely, and C-l (recenter) can
2142 correct the display anyway. */
2143 if (cmp->font != (void *) font)
2144 {
2145 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character of
2146 this composition (adjusted by baseline offset). Ascent
2147 and descent of overall glyphs should not be less than
2148 them respectively. */
2149 int font_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2150 int font_descent = font->descent - boff;
2151 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2152 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
2153 int i, width, ascent, descent;
2154
2155 cmp->font = (void *) font;
2156
2157 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
2158 if (font_info
2159 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2160 {
2161 width = pcm->width;
2162 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2163 descent = pcm->descent;
2164 }
2165 else
2166 {
2167 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2168 ascent = font->ascent;
2169 descent = font->descent;
2170 }
2171
2172 rightmost = width;
2173 lowest = - descent + boff;
2174 highest = ascent + boff;
2175 leftmost = 0;
2176
2177 if (font_info
2178 && font_info->default_ascent
2179 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
2180 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
2181 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
2182 highest = font_info->default_ascent + boff;
2183
2184 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
2185 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn at
2186 the left. */
2187 cmp->offsets[0] = 0;
2188 cmp->offsets[1] = boff;
2189
2190 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
2191 for (i = 1; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2192 {
2193 int left, right, btm, top;
2194 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
2195 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch);
2196
2197 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
2198 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face->id, &char2b,
2199 it->multibyte_p, 0);
2200 font = face->font;
2201 if (font == NULL)
2202 {
2203 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2204 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2205 font_info = NULL;
2206 }
2207 else
2208 {
2209 font_info
2210 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2211 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2212 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2213 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2214 }
2215
2216 if (font_info
2217 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2218 {
2219 width = pcm->width;
2220 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2221 descent = pcm->descent;
2222 }
2223 else
2224 {
2225 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2226 ascent = 1;
2227 descent = 0;
2228 }
2229
2230 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
2231 {
2232 /* Relative composition with or without
2233 alternate chars. */
2234 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
2235 btm = - descent + boff;
2236 if (font_info && font_info->relative_compose
2237 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
2238 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
2239 make_number (ch)))))
2240 {
2241
2242 if (- descent >= font_info->relative_compose)
2243 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2244 btm = highest + 1;
2245 else if (ascent <= 0)
2246 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2247 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
2248 }
2249 }
2250 else
2251 {
2252 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
2253 value that encodes global and new reference
2254 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
2255 specified by numbers as below:
2256
2257 0---1---2 -- ascent
2258 | |
2259 | |
2260 | |
2261 9--10--11 -- center
2262 | |
2263 ---3---4---5--- baseline
2264 | |
2265 6---7---8 -- descent
2266 */
2267 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
2268 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy;
2269
2270 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref);
2271 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
2272 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
2273
2274 left = (leftmost
2275 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
2276 - nrefx * width / 2);
2277 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
2278 : grefy == 1 ? 0
2279 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
2280 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
2281 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
2282 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
2283 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
2284 : (ascent + descent) / 2));
2285 }
2286
2287 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
2288 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
2289
2290 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2291 right = left + width;
2292 top = btm + descent + ascent;
2293 if (left < leftmost)
2294 leftmost = left;
2295 if (right > rightmost)
2296 rightmost = right;
2297 if (top > highest)
2298 highest = top;
2299 if (btm < lowest)
2300 lowest = btm;
2301 }
2302
2303 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
2304 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
2305 non-negative. */
2306 if (leftmost < 0)
2307 {
2308 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2309 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
2310 rightmost -= leftmost;
2311 }
2312
2313 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
2314 cmp->ascent = highest;
2315 cmp->descent = - lowest;
2316 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
2317 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
2318 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
2319 cmp->descent = font_descent;
2320 }
2321
2322 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
2323 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
2324 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
2325
2326 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2327 {
2328 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2329
2330 if (thick > 0)
2331 {
2332 it->ascent += thick;
2333 it->descent += thick;
2334 }
2335 else
2336 thick = - thick;
2337
2338 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2339 it->pixel_width += thick;
2340 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2341 it->pixel_width += thick;
2342 }
2343
2344 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2345 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2346 if (face->overline_p)
2347 it->ascent += 2;
2348
2349 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2350
2351 if (it->glyph_row)
2352 x_append_composite_glyph (it);
2353 }
2354 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
2355 x_produce_image_glyph (it);
2356 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
2357 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it);
2358
2359 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
2360 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
2361 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
2362 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
2363 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
2364
2365 it->descent += it->extra_line_spacing;
2366
2367 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
2368 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
2369 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
2370 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
2371 }
2372
2373
2374 /* Estimate the pixel height of the mode or top line on frame F.
2375 FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
2376
2377 int
2378 x_estimate_mode_line_height (f, face_id)
2379 struct frame *f;
2380 enum face_id face_id;
2381 {
2382 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
2383
2384 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
2385 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
2386 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
2387 {
2388 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
2389 if (face)
2390 {
2391 if (face->font)
2392 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
2393 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
2394 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
2395 }
2396 }
2397
2398 return height;
2399 }
2400
2401 \f
2402 /***********************************************************************
2403 Glyph display
2404 ***********************************************************************/
2405
2406 /* A sequence of glyphs to be drawn in the same face.
2407
2408 This data structure is not really completely X specific, so it
2409 could possibly, at least partially, be useful for other systems. It
2410 is currently not part of the external redisplay interface because
2411 it's not clear what other systems will need. */
2412
2413 struct glyph_string
2414 {
2415 /* X-origin of the string. */
2416 int x;
2417
2418 /* Y-origin and y-position of the base line of this string. */
2419 int y, ybase;
2420
2421 /* The width of the string, not including a face extension. */
2422 int width;
2423
2424 /* The width of the string, including a face extension. */
2425 int background_width;
2426
2427 /* The height of this string. This is the height of the line this
2428 string is drawn in, and can be different from the height of the
2429 font the string is drawn in. */
2430 int height;
2431
2432 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites in front of its x-origin.
2433 This number is zero if the string has an lbearing >= 0; it is
2434 -lbearing, if the string has an lbearing < 0. */
2435 int left_overhang;
2436
2437 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites past its right-most
2438 nominal x-position, i.e. x + width. Zero if the string's
2439 rbearing is <= its nominal width, rbearing - width otherwise. */
2440 int right_overhang;
2441
2442 /* The frame on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2443 struct frame *f;
2444
2445 /* The window on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2446 struct window *w;
2447
2448 /* X display and window for convenience. */
2449 Display *display;
2450 Window window;
2451
2452 /* The glyph row for which this string was built. It determines the
2453 y-origin and height of the string. */
2454 struct glyph_row *row;
2455
2456 /* The area within row. */
2457 enum glyph_row_area area;
2458
2459 /* Characters to be drawn, and number of characters. */
2460 XChar2b *char2b;
2461 int nchars;
2462
2463 /* A face-override for drawing cursors, mouse face and similar. */
2464 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
2465
2466 /* Face in which this string is to be drawn. */
2467 struct face *face;
2468
2469 /* Font in which this string is to be drawn. */
2470 XFontStruct *font;
2471
2472 /* Font info for this string. */
2473 struct font_info *font_info;
2474
2475 /* Non-null means this string describes (part of) a composition.
2476 All characters from char2b are drawn composed. */
2477 struct composition *cmp;
2478
2479 /* Index of this glyph string's first character in the glyph
2480 definition of CMP. If this is zero, this glyph string describes
2481 the first character of a composition. */
2482 int gidx;
2483
2484 /* 1 means this glyph strings face has to be drawn to the right end
2485 of the window's drawing area. */
2486 unsigned extends_to_end_of_line_p : 1;
2487
2488 /* 1 means the background of this string has been drawn. */
2489 unsigned background_filled_p : 1;
2490
2491 /* 1 means glyph string must be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
2492 unsigned two_byte_p : 1;
2493
2494 /* 1 means that the original font determined for drawing this glyph
2495 string could not be loaded. The member `font' has been set to
2496 the frame's default font in this case. */
2497 unsigned font_not_found_p : 1;
2498
2499 /* 1 means that the face in which this glyph string is drawn has a
2500 stipple pattern. */
2501 unsigned stippled_p : 1;
2502
2503 /* 1 means only the foreground of this glyph string must be drawn,
2504 and we should use the physical height of the line this glyph
2505 string appears in as clip rect. */
2506 unsigned for_overlaps_p : 1;
2507
2508 /* The GC to use for drawing this glyph string. */
2509 GC gc;
2510
2511 /* A pointer to the first glyph in the string. This glyph
2512 corresponds to char2b[0]. Needed to draw rectangles if
2513 font_not_found_p is 1. */
2514 struct glyph *first_glyph;
2515
2516 /* Image, if any. */
2517 struct image *img;
2518
2519 struct glyph_string *next, *prev;
2520 };
2521
2522
2523 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2524
2525 static void
2526 x_dump_glyph_string (s)
2527 struct glyph_string *s;
2528 {
2529 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
2530 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
2531 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
2532 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
2533 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
2534 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
2535 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
2536 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
2537 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
2538 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
2539 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
2540 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
2541 }
2542
2543 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
2544
2545
2546
2547 static void x_append_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2548 struct glyph_string **,
2549 struct glyph_string *,
2550 struct glyph_string *));
2551 static void x_prepend_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2552 struct glyph_string **,
2553 struct glyph_string *,
2554 struct glyph_string *));
2555 static void x_append_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2556 struct glyph_string **,
2557 struct glyph_string *));
2558 static int x_left_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2559 static int x_left_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2560 static int x_right_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2561 static int x_right_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2562 static int x_fill_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int,
2563 int));
2564 static void x_init_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2565 XChar2b *, struct window *,
2566 struct glyph_row *,
2567 enum glyph_row_area, int,
2568 enum draw_glyphs_face));
2569 static int x_draw_glyphs P_ ((struct window *, int , struct glyph_row *,
2570 enum glyph_row_area, int, int,
2571 enum draw_glyphs_face, int));
2572 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2573 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2574 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2575 int));
2576 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2577 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2578 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2579 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2580 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2581 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2582 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2583 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2584 static void x_get_glyph_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph *, struct frame *,
2585 int *, int *));
2586 static void x_compute_overhangs_and_x P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int));
2587 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
2588 unsigned long *, double, int));
2589 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
2590 double, int, unsigned long));
2591 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2592 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2593 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2594 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2595 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
2596 static void x_fill_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2597 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
2598 int, int, int));
2599 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
2600 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2601 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
2602 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2603 static void x_fix_overlapping_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
2604 enum glyph_row_area));
2605 static int x_fill_stretch_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2606 struct glyph_row *,
2607 enum glyph_row_area, int, int));
2608
2609 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2610 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
2611 #endif
2612
2613
2614 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
2615 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
2616
2617 static INLINE void
2618 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2619 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2620 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2621 {
2622 if (h)
2623 {
2624 if (*head)
2625 (*tail)->next = h;
2626 else
2627 *head = h;
2628 h->prev = *tail;
2629 *tail = t;
2630 }
2631 }
2632
2633
2634 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
2635 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
2636 result. */
2637
2638 static INLINE void
2639 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2640 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2641 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2642 {
2643 if (h)
2644 {
2645 if (*head)
2646 (*head)->prev = t;
2647 else
2648 *tail = t;
2649 t->next = *head;
2650 *head = h;
2651 }
2652 }
2653
2654
2655 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
2656 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
2657
2658 static INLINE void
2659 x_append_glyph_string (head, tail, s)
2660 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2661 struct glyph_string *s;
2662 {
2663 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
2664 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
2665 }
2666
2667
2668 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
2669 face. */
2670
2671 static void
2672 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
2673 struct glyph_string *s;
2674 {
2675 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
2676 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2677 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2678 && !s->cmp)
2679 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
2680 else
2681 {
2682 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
2683 XGCValues xgcv;
2684 unsigned long mask;
2685
2686 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
2687 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2688
2689 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
2690 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2691 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2692 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2693 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
2694 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2695 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2696
2697 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
2698 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
2699 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
2700 {
2701 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
2702 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2703 }
2704
2705 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2706 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2707 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2708 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2709
2710 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2711 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2712 mask, &xgcv);
2713 else
2714 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2715 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2716
2717 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2718 }
2719 }
2720
2721
2722 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
2723
2724 static void
2725 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
2726 struct glyph_string *s;
2727 {
2728 int face_id;
2729 struct face *face;
2730
2731 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
2732 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
2733 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2734 if (face == NULL)
2735 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
2736
2737 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2738 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
2739 else
2740 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
2741 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2742 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2743
2744 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
2745 if (s->font == s->face->font)
2746 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2747 else
2748 {
2749 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
2750 but font FONT. */
2751 XGCValues xgcv;
2752 unsigned long mask;
2753
2754 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
2755 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2756 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2757 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2758 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2759 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2760
2761 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2762 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2763 mask, &xgcv);
2764 else
2765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2766 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2767
2768 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2769 }
2770
2771 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2772 }
2773
2774
2775 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
2776 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
2777 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
2778
2779 static INLINE void
2780 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
2781 struct glyph_string *s;
2782 {
2783 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2784 }
2785
2786
2787 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
2788 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
2789 pattern. */
2790
2791 static INLINE void
2792 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
2793 struct glyph_string *s;
2794 {
2795 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2796
2797 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
2798 {
2799 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2800 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2801 }
2802 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
2803 {
2804 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
2805 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2806 }
2807 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2808 {
2809 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
2810 s->stippled_p = 0;
2811 }
2812 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
2813 {
2814 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2815 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2816 }
2817 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2818 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2819 {
2820 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2821 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2822 }
2823 else
2824 {
2825 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2826 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2827 }
2828
2829 /* GC must have been set. */
2830 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2831 }
2832
2833
2834 /* Return in *R the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2835
2836 static void
2837 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, r)
2838 struct glyph_string *s;
2839 XRectangle *r;
2840 {
2841 if (s->row->full_width_p)
2842 {
2843 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left. */
2844 int canon_x = CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
2845
2846 r->x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (s->w) * canon_x;
2847 r->width = XFASTINT (s->w->width) * canon_x;
2848
2849 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (s->f))
2850 {
2851 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * canon_x;
2852 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (s->f))
2853 r->x -= width;
2854 }
2855
2856 r->x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (s->f);
2857
2858 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
2859 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
2860 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2861 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2862 else
2863 r->height = s->height;
2864 }
2865 else
2866 {
2867 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
2868 r->x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->area, 0);
2869 r->width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
2870 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2871 }
2872
2873 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2874 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2875 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2876 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2877 {
2878 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2879 r->height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r->y;
2880 }
2881 else
2882 {
2883 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2884 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2885 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2886 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2887 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2888 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2889 else
2890 r->y = max (0, s->row->y);
2891
2892 /* If drawing a tool-bar window, draw it over the internal border
2893 at the top of the window. */
2894 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
2895 r->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
2896 }
2897
2898 r->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r->y);
2899 }
2900
2901
2902 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
2903 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
2904
2905 static INLINE void
2906 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
2907 struct glyph_string *s;
2908 {
2909 XRectangle r;
2910 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2911 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2912 }
2913
2914
2915 /* Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
2916 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
2917
2918 static INLINE void
2919 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
2920 struct glyph_string *s;
2921 {
2922 if (s->cmp == NULL
2923 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2924 {
2925 XCharStruct cs;
2926 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
2927 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
2928 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
2929 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
2930 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
2931 }
2932 }
2933
2934
2935 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
2936 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
2937 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
2938
2939 static void
2940 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (s, x, backward_p)
2941 struct glyph_string *s;
2942 int x;
2943 int backward_p;
2944 {
2945 if (backward_p)
2946 {
2947 while (s)
2948 {
2949 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2950 x -= s->width;
2951 s->x = x;
2952 s = s->prev;
2953 }
2954 }
2955 else
2956 {
2957 while (s)
2958 {
2959 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2960 s->x = x;
2961 x += s->width;
2962 s = s->next;
2963 }
2964 }
2965 }
2966
2967
2968 /* Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
2969 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
2970 assumed to be zero. */
2971
2972 static void
2973 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, f, left, right)
2974 struct glyph *glyph;
2975 struct frame *f;
2976 int *left, *right;
2977 {
2978 *left = *right = 0;
2979
2980 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2981 {
2982 XFontStruct *font;
2983 struct face *face;
2984 struct font_info *font_info;
2985 XChar2b char2b;
2986 XCharStruct *pcm;
2987
2988 face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
2989 font = face->font;
2990 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
2991 if (font
2992 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2993 {
2994 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
2995 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
2996 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
2997 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
2998 }
2999 }
3000 }
3001
3002
3003 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3004 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
3005 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
3006
3007 static int
3008 x_left_overwritten (s)
3009 struct glyph_string *s;
3010 {
3011 int k;
3012
3013 if (s->left_overhang)
3014 {
3015 int x = 0, i;
3016 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3017 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3018
3019 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
3020 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3021
3022 k = i + 1;
3023 }
3024 else
3025 k = -1;
3026
3027 return k;
3028 }
3029
3030
3031 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3032 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
3033 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
3034
3035 static int
3036 x_left_overwriting (s)
3037 struct glyph_string *s;
3038 {
3039 int i, k, x;
3040 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3041 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3042
3043 k = -1;
3044 x = 0;
3045 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3046 {
3047 int left, right;
3048 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3049 if (x + right > 0)
3050 k = i;
3051 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3052 }
3053
3054 return k;
3055 }
3056
3057
3058 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
3059 not overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
3060 no such glyph is found. */
3061
3062 static int
3063 x_right_overwritten (s)
3064 struct glyph_string *s;
3065 {
3066 int k = -1;
3067
3068 if (s->right_overhang)
3069 {
3070 int x = 0, i;
3071 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3072 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3073 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3074
3075 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
3076 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3077
3078 k = i;
3079 }
3080
3081 return k;
3082 }
3083
3084
3085 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
3086 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
3087 if no such glyph is found. */
3088
3089 static int
3090 x_right_overwriting (s)
3091 struct glyph_string *s;
3092 {
3093 int i, k, x;
3094 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3095 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3096 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3097
3098 k = -1;
3099 x = 0;
3100 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
3101 {
3102 int left, right;
3103 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3104 if (x - left < 0)
3105 k = i;
3106 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3107 }
3108
3109 return k;
3110 }
3111
3112
3113 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
3114
3115 static INLINE void
3116 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
3117 struct glyph_string *s;
3118 int x, y, w, h;
3119 {
3120 XGCValues xgcv;
3121 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
3122 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
3123 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
3124 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3125 }
3126
3127
3128 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
3129 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
3130 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
3131 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
3132 contains the first component of a composition. */
3133
3134 static void
3135 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
3136 struct glyph_string *s;
3137 int force_p;
3138 {
3139 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
3140 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
3141 if (!s->background_filled_p)
3142 {
3143 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
3144
3145 if (s->stippled_p)
3146 {
3147 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3148 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3149 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
3150 s->y + box_line_width,
3151 s->background_width,
3152 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3153 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3154 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3155 }
3156 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
3157 || s->font_not_found_p
3158 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
3159 || force_p)
3160 {
3161 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
3162 s->background_width,
3163 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3164 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3165 }
3166 }
3167 }
3168
3169
3170 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
3171
3172 static void
3173 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3174 struct glyph_string *s;
3175 {
3176 int i, x;
3177
3178 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3179 of S to the right of that box line. */
3180 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3181 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3182 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3183 else
3184 x = s->x;
3185
3186 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
3187 loaded. */
3188 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3189 {
3190 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3191 {
3192 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
3193 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
3194 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
3195 s->height - 1);
3196 x += g->pixel_width;
3197 }
3198 }
3199 else
3200 {
3201 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
3202 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
3203
3204 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
3205 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
3206
3207 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
3208 if (!s->two_byte_p)
3209 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3210 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
3211
3212 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
3213 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
3214 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
3215 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
3216 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
3217 if (s->for_overlaps_p
3218 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
3219 {
3220 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
3221 if (s->two_byte_p)
3222 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3223 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3224 else
3225 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3226 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3227 }
3228 else
3229 {
3230 if (s->two_byte_p)
3231 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3232 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3233 else
3234 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3235 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3236 }
3237
3238 if (s->face->overstrike)
3239 {
3240 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
3241 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
3242 if (s->two_byte_p)
3243 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
3244 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3245 else
3246 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
3247 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3248 }
3249 }
3250 }
3251
3252 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
3253
3254 static void
3255 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3256 struct glyph_string *s;
3257 {
3258 int i, x;
3259
3260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3261 of S to the right of that box line. */
3262 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3263 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3264 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3265 else
3266 x = s->x;
3267
3268 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
3269 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
3270 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
3271 this composition. */
3272
3273 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
3274 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
3275 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3276 {
3277 if (s->gidx == 0)
3278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
3279 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
3280 }
3281 else
3282 {
3283 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
3284 {
3285 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3286 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
3287 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3288 s->char2b + i, 1);
3289 if (s->face->overstrike)
3290 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3291 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
3292 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3293 s->char2b + i, 1);
3294 }
3295 }
3296 }
3297
3298
3299 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3300
3301 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
3302 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
3303 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
3304 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
3305 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
3306
3307
3308 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
3309 cannot be determined. */
3310
3311 static struct frame *
3312 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
3313 Widget widget;
3314 {
3315 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3316 Lisp_Object tail;
3317 struct frame *f;
3318
3319 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
3320
3321 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
3322 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
3323 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
3324 x_any_window_to_frame. */
3325 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
3326 widget = XtParent (widget);
3327
3328 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
3329 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
3330 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3331 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
3332 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
3333 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
3334 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
3335 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
3336 return f;
3337
3338 abort ();
3339 }
3340
3341
3342 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
3343 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
3344 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
3345 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
3346
3347 int
3348 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
3349 Widget widget;
3350 Colormap cmap;
3351 XColor *color;
3352 {
3353 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3354 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
3355 }
3356
3357
3358 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3359 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3360 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3361 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3362 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3363 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3364
3365 int
3366 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3367 Widget widget;
3368 Display *display;
3369 Colormap cmap;
3370 unsigned long *pixel;
3371 double factor;
3372 int delta;
3373 {
3374 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3375 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
3376 }
3377
3378
3379 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
3380 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
3381
3382 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
3383 {
3384 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
3385 sizeof (Screen *)},
3386 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
3387 sizeof (Colormap)}
3388 };
3389
3390
3391 /* The address of this variable is returned by
3392 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3393
3394 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3395
3396
3397 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
3398
3399 DPY is the display we are working on.
3400
3401 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
3402 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
3403 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
3404 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
3405
3406 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
3407 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
3408
3409 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
3410 we allocated the color or not.
3411
3412 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
3413
3414 static Boolean
3415 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
3416 Display *dpy;
3417 XrmValue *args;
3418 Cardinal *nargs;
3419 XrmValue *from, *to;
3420 XtPointer *closure_ret;
3421 {
3422 Screen *screen;
3423 Colormap cmap;
3424 Pixel pixel;
3425 String color_name;
3426 XColor color;
3427
3428 if (*nargs != 2)
3429 {
3430 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3431 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3432 "XtToolkitError",
3433 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
3434 return False;
3435 }
3436
3437 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3438 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3439 color_name = (String) from->addr;
3440
3441 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
3442 {
3443 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3444 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
3445 }
3446 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
3447 {
3448 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3449 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
3450 }
3451 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
3452 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
3453 {
3454 pixel = color.pixel;
3455 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
3456 }
3457 else
3458 {
3459 String params[1];
3460 Cardinal nparams = 1;
3461
3462 params[0] = color_name;
3463 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3464 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3465 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
3466 params, &nparams);
3467 return False;
3468 }
3469
3470 if (to->addr != NULL)
3471 {
3472 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
3473 {
3474 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3475 return False;
3476 }
3477
3478 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
3479 }
3480 else
3481 {
3482 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
3483 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3484 }
3485
3486 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3487 return True;
3488 }
3489
3490
3491 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
3492 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
3493 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
3494
3495 APP is the application context in which we work.
3496
3497 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
3498 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
3499 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
3500
3501 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3502
3503 static void
3504 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
3505 XtAppContext app;
3506 XrmValuePtr to;
3507 XtPointer closure;
3508 XrmValuePtr args;
3509 Cardinal *nargs;
3510 {
3511 if (*nargs != 2)
3512 {
3513 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
3514 "XtToolkitError",
3515 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
3516 NULL, NULL);
3517 }
3518 else if (closure != NULL)
3519 {
3520 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
3521 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3522 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3523 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
3524 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
3525 }
3526 }
3527
3528
3529 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3530
3531
3532 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
3533 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
3534 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
3535 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
3536
3537 static const XColor *
3538 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
3539 Display *dpy;
3540 int *ncells;
3541 {
3542 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3543
3544 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
3545 {
3546 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
3547 int i;
3548
3549 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3550 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
3551 dpyinfo->color_cells
3552 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3553 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
3554
3555 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
3556 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
3557
3558 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
3559 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3560 }
3561
3562 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
3563 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
3564 }
3565
3566
3567 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
3568 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
3569
3570 void
3571 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
3572 struct frame *f;
3573 XColor *colors;
3574 int ncolors;
3575 {
3576 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3577
3578 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
3579 {
3580 int i;
3581 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
3582 {
3583 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
3584 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3585 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
3586 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
3587 }
3588 }
3589 else
3590 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
3591 }
3592
3593
3594 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
3595 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
3596
3597 void
3598 x_query_color (f, color)
3599 struct frame *f;
3600 XColor *color;
3601 {
3602 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
3603 }
3604
3605
3606 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
3607 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3608 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3609 allocated. */
3610
3611 static int
3612 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
3613 Display *dpy;
3614 Colormap cmap;
3615 XColor *color;
3616 {
3617 int rc;
3618
3619 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3620 if (rc == 0)
3621 {
3622 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
3623 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
3624 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
3625 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
3626 int nearest, i;
3627 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
3628 int ncells;
3629 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
3630
3631 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3632 {
3633 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
3634 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
3635 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
3636 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
3637
3638 if (delta < nearest_delta)
3639 {
3640 nearest = i;
3641 nearest_delta = delta;
3642 }
3643 }
3644
3645 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
3646 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
3647 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
3648 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3649 }
3650 else
3651 {
3652 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
3653 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
3654 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
3655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3656 XColor *cached_color;
3657
3658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
3659 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
3660 (cached_color->red != color->red
3661 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
3662 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
3663 {
3664 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
3665 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
3666 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
3667 }
3668 }
3669
3670 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3671 if (rc)
3672 register_color (color->pixel);
3673 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
3674
3675 return rc;
3676 }
3677
3678
3679 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
3680 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3681 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3682 allocated. */
3683
3684 int
3685 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
3686 struct frame *f;
3687 Colormap cmap;
3688 XColor *color;
3689 {
3690 gamma_correct (f, color);
3691 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
3692 }
3693
3694
3695 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3696 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3697 get color reference counts right. */
3698
3699 unsigned long
3700 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
3701 struct frame *f;
3702 unsigned long pixel;
3703 {
3704 XColor color;
3705
3706 color.pixel = pixel;
3707 BLOCK_INPUT;
3708 x_query_color (f, &color);
3709 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3710 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3711 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3712 register_color (pixel);
3713 #endif
3714 return color.pixel;
3715 }
3716
3717
3718 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3719 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3720 get color reference counts right. */
3721
3722 unsigned long
3723 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
3724 Display *dpy;
3725 Colormap cmap;
3726 unsigned long pixel;
3727 {
3728 XColor color;
3729
3730 color.pixel = pixel;
3731 BLOCK_INPUT;
3732 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3733 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3734 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3735 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3736 register_color (pixel);
3737 #endif
3738 return color.pixel;
3739 }
3740
3741
3742 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
3743 boosted.
3744
3745 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
3746 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
3747 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
3748 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
3749 use an additional additive factor.
3750
3751 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
3752 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
3753 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
3754
3755
3756 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3757 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3758 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3759 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3760 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3761 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3762
3763 static int
3764 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3765 struct frame *f;
3766 Display *display;
3767 Colormap cmap;
3768 unsigned long *pixel;
3769 double factor;
3770 int delta;
3771 {
3772 XColor color, new;
3773 long bright;
3774 int success_p;
3775
3776 /* Get RGB color values. */
3777 color.pixel = *pixel;
3778 x_query_color (f, &color);
3779
3780 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
3781 xassert (factor >= 0);
3782 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
3783 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
3784 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
3785
3786 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
3787 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
3788
3789 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
3790 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
3791 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
3792 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
3793 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
3794 {
3795 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
3796 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
3797 /* The additive adjustment. */
3798 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
3799
3800 if (factor < 1)
3801 {
3802 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
3803 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
3804 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
3805 }
3806 else
3807 {
3808 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
3809 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
3810 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
3811 }
3812 }
3813
3814 /* Try to allocate the color. */
3815 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3816 if (success_p)
3817 {
3818 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
3819 {
3820 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
3821 delta to the RGB values. */
3822 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
3823
3824 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
3825 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
3826 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
3827 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3828 }
3829 else
3830 success_p = 1;
3831 *pixel = new.pixel;
3832 }
3833
3834 return success_p;
3835 }
3836
3837
3838 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
3839 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
3840 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
3841 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
3842 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
3843 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
3844
3845 static void
3846 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
3847 struct frame *f;
3848 struct relief *relief;
3849 double factor;
3850 int delta;
3851 unsigned long default_pixel;
3852 {
3853 XGCValues xgcv;
3854 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
3855 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
3856 unsigned long pixel;
3857 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
3858 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
3859 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3860 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3861
3862 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
3863 xgcv.line_width = 1;
3864
3865 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
3866 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
3867 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
3868 if (relief->gc
3869 && relief->allocated_p)
3870 {
3871 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
3872 relief->allocated_p = 0;
3873 }
3874
3875 /* Allocate new color. */
3876 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
3877 pixel = background;
3878 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
3879 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
3880 {
3881 relief->allocated_p = 1;
3882 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
3883 }
3884
3885 if (relief->gc == 0)
3886 {
3887 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
3888 mask |= GCStipple;
3889 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
3890 }
3891 else
3892 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3893 }
3894
3895
3896 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
3897
3898 static void
3899 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
3900 struct glyph_string *s;
3901 {
3902 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
3903 unsigned long color;
3904
3905 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
3906 color = s->face->box_color;
3907 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
3908 && s->img->pixmap
3909 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
3910 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
3911 else
3912 {
3913 XGCValues xgcv;
3914
3915 /* Get the background color of the face. */
3916 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
3917 color = xgcv.background;
3918 }
3919
3920 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
3921 || color != di->relief_background)
3922 {
3923 di->relief_background = color;
3924 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
3925 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3926 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
3927 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3928 }
3929 }
3930
3931
3932 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
3933 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
3934 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
3935 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
3936 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
3937 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
3938 when drawing. */
3939
3940 static void
3941 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3942 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3943 struct frame *f;
3944 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
3945 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3946 {
3947 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3948 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
3949 int i;
3950 GC gc;
3951
3952 if (raised_p)
3953 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3954 else
3955 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3956 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3957
3958 /* Top. */
3959 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3960 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3961 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
3962 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
3963
3964 /* Left. */
3965 if (left_p)
3966 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3967 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3968 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
3969
3970 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3971 if (raised_p)
3972 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3973 else
3974 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3975 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3976
3977 /* Bottom. */
3978 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3979 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3980 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
3981 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
3982
3983 /* Right. */
3984 if (right_p)
3985 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3986 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3987 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
3988
3989 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3990 }
3991
3992
3993 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
3994 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
3995 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
3996 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
3997 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
3998 rectangle to use when drawing. */
3999
4000 static void
4001 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4002 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
4003 struct glyph_string *s;
4004 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
4005 XRectangle *clip_rect;
4006 {
4007 XGCValues xgcv;
4008
4009 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4010 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
4011 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
4012
4013 /* Top. */
4014 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4015 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
4016
4017 /* Left. */
4018 if (left_p)
4019 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4020 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
4021
4022 /* Bottom. */
4023 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4024 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
4025
4026 /* Right. */
4027 if (right_p)
4028 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4029 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
4030
4031 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4032 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4033 }
4034
4035
4036 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
4037
4038 static void
4039 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
4040 struct glyph_string *s;
4041 {
4042 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
4043 int left_p, right_p;
4044 struct glyph *last_glyph;
4045 XRectangle clip_rect;
4046
4047 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
4048 if (s->row->full_width_p
4049 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
4050 {
4051 last_x += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->f);
4052 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (s->f))
4053 last_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
4054 }
4055
4056 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
4057 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
4058 ? s->first_glyph
4059 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
4060
4061 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4062 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
4063 left_x = s->x;
4064 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
4065 ? last_x - 1
4066 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
4067 top_y = s->y;
4068 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
4069
4070 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
4071 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4072 && (s->prev == NULL
4073 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
4074 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
4075 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4076 && (s->next == NULL
4077 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
4078
4079 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4080
4081 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
4082 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4083 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4084 else
4085 {
4086 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4087 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
4088 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4089 }
4090 }
4091
4092
4093 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
4094
4095 static void
4096 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
4097 struct glyph_string *s;
4098 {
4099 int x;
4100 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4101
4102 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4103 right of that line. */
4104 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4105 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4106 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4107 else
4108 x = s->x;
4109
4110 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4111 by that margin. */
4112 x += s->img->hmargin;
4113 y += s->img->vmargin;
4114
4115 if (s->img->pixmap)
4116 {
4117 if (s->img->mask)
4118 {
4119 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4120 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4121 trust on the shape extension to be available
4122 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4123 manually. */
4124 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4125 | GCFunction);
4126 XGCValues xgcv;
4127 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4128
4129 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4130 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4131 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4132 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4133 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4134
4135 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4136 image_rect.x = x;
4137 image_rect.y = y;
4138 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4139 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4140 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4141 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4142 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4143 }
4144 else
4145 {
4146 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4147
4148 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4149 image_rect.x = x;
4150 image_rect.y = y;
4151 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4152 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4153 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4154 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4155 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4156
4157 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4158 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4159 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4160 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4161 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4162 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4163 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4164 {
4165 int r = s->img->relief;
4166 if (r < 0) r = -r;
4167 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
4168 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
4169 }
4170 }
4171 }
4172 else
4173 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4174 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4175 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4176 }
4177
4178
4179 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
4180
4181 static void
4182 x_draw_image_relief (s)
4183 struct glyph_string *s;
4184 {
4185 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
4186 XRectangle r;
4187 int x;
4188 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4189
4190 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4191 right of that line. */
4192 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4193 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4194 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4195 else
4196 x = s->x;
4197
4198 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4199 by that margin. */
4200 x += s->img->hmargin;
4201 y += s->img->vmargin;
4202
4203 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
4204 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
4205 {
4206 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
4207 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
4208 }
4209 else
4210 {
4211 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
4212 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
4213 }
4214
4215 x0 = x - thick;
4216 y0 = y - thick;
4217 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
4218 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
4219
4220 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4221 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4222 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
4223 }
4224
4225
4226 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
4227
4228 static void
4229 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
4230 struct glyph_string *s;
4231 Pixmap pixmap;
4232 {
4233 int x;
4234 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4235
4236 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4237 right of that line. */
4238 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4239 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4240 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4241 else
4242 x = 0;
4243
4244 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4245 by that margin. */
4246 x += s->img->hmargin;
4247 y += s->img->vmargin;
4248
4249 if (s->img->pixmap)
4250 {
4251 if (s->img->mask)
4252 {
4253 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4254 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4255 trust on the shape extension to be available
4256 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4257 manually. */
4258 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4259 | GCFunction);
4260 XGCValues xgcv;
4261
4262 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4263 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4264 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4265 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4266 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4267
4268 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4269 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4270 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4271 }
4272 else
4273 {
4274 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4275 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4276
4277 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4278 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4279 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4280 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4281 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4282 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4283 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4284 {
4285 int r = s->img->relief;
4286 if (r < 0) r = -r;
4287 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
4288 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
4289 }
4290 }
4291 }
4292 else
4293 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4294 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4295 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4296 }
4297
4298
4299 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
4300 give the rectangle to draw. */
4301
4302 static void
4303 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
4304 struct glyph_string *s;
4305 int x, y, w, h;
4306 {
4307 if (s->stippled_p)
4308 {
4309 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4310 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4311 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
4312 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4313 }
4314 else
4315 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
4316 }
4317
4318
4319 /* Draw image glyph string S.
4320
4321 s->y
4322 s->x +-------------------------
4323 | s->face->box
4324 |
4325 | +-------------------------
4326 | | s->img->margin
4327 | |
4328 | | +-------------------
4329 | | | the image
4330
4331 */
4332
4333 static void
4334 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
4335 struct glyph_string *s;
4336 {
4337 int x, y;
4338 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4339 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
4340 int height;
4341 Pixmap pixmap = None;
4342
4343 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
4344
4345
4346 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
4347 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
4348 flickering. */
4349 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4350 if (height > s->img->height
4351 || s->img->hmargin
4352 || s->img->vmargin
4353 || s->img->mask
4354 || s->img->pixmap == 0
4355 || s->width != s->background_width)
4356 {
4357 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4358 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
4359 else
4360 x = s->x;
4361
4362 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
4363
4364 if (s->img->mask)
4365 {
4366 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
4367 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
4368 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
4369 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
4370 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
4371
4372 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
4373 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
4374 s->background_width,
4375 s->height, depth);
4376
4377 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
4378 pixmap. */
4379 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4380
4381 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
4382 if (s->stippled_p)
4383 {
4384 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4385 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4386 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4387 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4388 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4389 }
4390 else
4391 {
4392 XGCValues xgcv;
4393 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
4394 &xgcv);
4395 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
4396 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4397 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4398 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4399 }
4400 }
4401 else
4402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
4403
4404 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4405 }
4406
4407 /* Draw the foreground. */
4408 if (pixmap != None)
4409 {
4410 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
4411 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4412 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4413 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
4414 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
4415 }
4416 else
4417 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
4418
4419 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
4420 if (s->img->relief
4421 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
4422 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4423 x_draw_image_relief (s);
4424 }
4425
4426
4427 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
4428
4429 static void
4430 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
4431 struct glyph_string *s;
4432 {
4433 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4434 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4435
4436 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
4437 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
4438 {
4439 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
4440 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
4441 int width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (s->f), s->background_width);
4442
4443 /* Draw cursor. */
4444 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
4445
4446 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
4447 if (width < s->background_width)
4448 {
4449 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
4450 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
4451 XRectangle r;
4452 GC gc;
4453
4454 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
4455 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
4456 {
4457 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
4458 gc = s->gc;
4459 }
4460 else
4461 gc = s->face->gc;
4462
4463 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4464 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
4465
4466 if (s->face->stipple)
4467 {
4468 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4469 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4470 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4471 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
4472 }
4473 else
4474 {
4475 XGCValues xgcv;
4476 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
4477 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
4478 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4479 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
4480 }
4481 }
4482 }
4483 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
4484 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
4485 s->height);
4486
4487 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4488 }
4489
4490
4491 /* Draw glyph string S. */
4492
4493 static void
4494 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
4495 struct glyph_string *s;
4496 {
4497 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
4498
4499 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
4500 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
4501 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
4502 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
4503 {
4504 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
4505 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
4506 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
4507 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
4508 }
4509
4510 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
4511 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
4512
4513 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
4514 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
4515 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
4516 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4517 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4518 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
4519
4520 {
4521 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4522 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4523 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4524 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4525 relief_drawn_p = 1;
4526 }
4527 else
4528 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4529
4530 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
4531 {
4532 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
4533 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
4534 break;
4535
4536 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
4537 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
4538 break;
4539
4540 case CHAR_GLYPH:
4541 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
4542 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4543 else
4544 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
4545 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4546 break;
4547
4548 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
4549 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
4550 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4551 else
4552 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4553 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4554 break;
4555
4556 default:
4557 abort ();
4558 }
4559
4560 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
4561 {
4562 /* Draw underline. */
4563 if (s->face->underline_p)
4564 {
4565 unsigned long tem, h;
4566 int y;
4567
4568 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
4569 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
4570 h = 1;
4571
4572 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
4573 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
4574 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
4575 specs, and its default is
4576
4577 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
4578 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
4579
4580 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
4581 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
4582 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
4583 else if (s->face->font)
4584 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
4585 else
4586 y = s->y + s->height - h;
4587
4588 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
4589 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4590 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4591 else
4592 {
4593 XGCValues xgcv;
4594 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4595 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
4596 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4597 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4598 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4599 }
4600 }
4601
4602 /* Draw overline. */
4603 if (s->face->overline_p)
4604 {
4605 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
4606
4607 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
4608 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4609 s->width, h);
4610 else
4611 {
4612 XGCValues xgcv;
4613 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4614 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
4615 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4616 s->width, h);
4617 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4618 }
4619 }
4620
4621 /* Draw strike-through. */
4622 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
4623 {
4624 unsigned long h = 1;
4625 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
4626
4627 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
4628 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4629 s->width, h);
4630 else
4631 {
4632 XGCValues xgcv;
4633 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4634 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
4635 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4636 s->width, h);
4637 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4638 }
4639 }
4640
4641 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
4642 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
4643 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4644 }
4645
4646 /* Reset clipping. */
4647 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4648 }
4649
4650
4651 static int x_fill_composite_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
4652 struct face **, int));
4653
4654
4655 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
4656
4657 FACES is an array of faces for all components of this composition.
4658 S->gidx is the index of the first component for S.
4659 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4660 use its physical height for clipping.
4661
4662 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
4663
4664 static int
4665 x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, overlaps_p)
4666 struct glyph_string *s;
4667 struct face **faces;
4668 int overlaps_p;
4669 {
4670 int i;
4671
4672 xassert (s);
4673
4674 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p;
4675
4676 s->face = faces[s->gidx];
4677 s->font = s->face->font;
4678 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4679
4680 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
4681 S->gidx, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
4682 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
4683 ++s->nchars;
4684 for (i = s->gidx + 1; i < s->cmp->glyph_len && faces[i] == s->face; ++i)
4685 ++s->nchars;
4686
4687 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
4688 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
4689
4690 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4691
4692 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
4693 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4694 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
4695 characters of the glyph string. */
4696 if (s->font == NULL)
4697 {
4698 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4699 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4700 }
4701
4702 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4703 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4704
4705 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4706
4707 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
4708 s->two_byte_p = 1;
4709
4710 return s->gidx + s->nchars;
4711 }
4712
4713
4714 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
4715
4716 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
4717 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4718 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4719 use its physical height for clipping.
4720
4721 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4722
4723 static int
4724 x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, start, end, overlaps_p)
4725 struct glyph_string *s;
4726 int face_id;
4727 int start, end, overlaps_p;
4728 {
4729 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4730 int voffset;
4731 int glyph_not_available_p;
4732
4733 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
4734 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
4735 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
4736
4737 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p,
4738 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4739 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4740 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4741
4742 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
4743
4744 while (glyph < last
4745 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4746 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4747 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
4748 && glyph->face_id == face_id
4749 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
4750 {
4751 int two_byte_p;
4752
4753 s->face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
4754 s->char2b + s->nchars,
4755 &two_byte_p);
4756 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
4757 ++s->nchars;
4758 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
4759 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4760 ++glyph;
4761 }
4762
4763 s->font = s->face->font;
4764 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4765
4766 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
4767 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4768 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
4769 characters of the glyph string. */
4770 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
4771 {
4772 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4773 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4774 }
4775
4776 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4777 s->ybase += voffset;
4778
4779 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4780 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4781 }
4782
4783
4784 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
4785
4786 static void
4787 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s)
4788 struct glyph_string *s;
4789 {
4790 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
4791 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
4792 xassert (s->img);
4793 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
4794 s->font = s->face->font;
4795 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4796
4797 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4798 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4799 }
4800
4801
4802 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
4803
4804 ROW is the glyph row in which the glyphs are found, AREA is the
4805 area within the row. START is the index of the first glyph to
4806 consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4807
4808 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4809
4810 static int
4811 x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, row, area, start, end)
4812 struct glyph_string *s;
4813 struct glyph_row *row;
4814 enum glyph_row_area area;
4815 int start, end;
4816 {
4817 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4818 int voffset, face_id;
4819
4820 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4821
4822 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4823 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4824 face_id = glyph->face_id;
4825 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
4826 s->font = s->face->font;
4827 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4828 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
4829 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4830
4831 for (++glyph;
4832 (glyph < last
4833 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
4834 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4835 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
4836 ++glyph)
4837 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4838
4839 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4840 s->ybase += voffset;
4841
4842 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
4843 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
4844 xassert (s->face);
4845 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4846 }
4847
4848
4849 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
4850 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
4851 x_init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
4852 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
4853 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
4854 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
4855 face-override for drawing S. */
4856
4857 static void
4858 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
4859 struct glyph_string *s;
4860 XChar2b *char2b;
4861 struct window *w;
4862 struct glyph_row *row;
4863 enum glyph_row_area area;
4864 int start;
4865 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4866 {
4867 bzero (s, sizeof *s);
4868 s->w = w;
4869 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4870 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
4871 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
4872 s->char2b = char2b;
4873 s->hl = hl;
4874 s->row = row;
4875 s->area = area;
4876 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
4877 s->height = row->height;
4878 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
4879
4880 /* Display the internal border below the tool-bar window. */
4881 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
4882 s->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
4883
4884 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
4885 }
4886
4887
4888 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
4889 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
4890 in the drawing area. */
4891
4892 static INLINE void
4893 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, start, last_x)
4894 struct glyph_string *s;
4895 int start;
4896 int last_x;
4897 {
4898 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
4899 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
4900 struct face *default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
4901
4902 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
4903 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
4904 && ((s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
4905 && (s->row->fill_line_p
4906 || s->face->background != default_face->background
4907 || s->face->stipple != default_face->stipple
4908 || s->row->mouse_face_p))
4909 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4910 || ((s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4911 && s->row->fill_line_p)))
4912 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
4913
4914 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
4915 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
4916 area. */
4917 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
4918 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
4919 else
4920 s->background_width = s->width;
4921 }
4922
4923
4924 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
4925 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
4926 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4927 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4928 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4929 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4930 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4931
4932 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
4933 and below -- keep them on one line. */
4934 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4935 do \
4936 { \
4937 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4938 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4939 START = x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, ROW, AREA, START, END); \
4940 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4941 s->x = (X); \
4942 } \
4943 while (0)
4944
4945
4946 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
4947 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
4948 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4949 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4950 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4951 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4952 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4953
4954 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4955 do \
4956 { \
4957 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4958 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4959 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
4960 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4961 ++START; \
4962 s->x = (X); \
4963 } \
4964 while (0)
4965
4966
4967 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
4968 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
4969 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
4970 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
4971 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
4972 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
4973 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
4974 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4975
4976 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4977 do \
4978 { \
4979 int c, face_id; \
4980 XChar2b *char2b; \
4981 \
4982 c = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.ch; \
4983 face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4984 \
4985 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4986 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
4987 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4988 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4989 s->x = (X); \
4990 START = x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
4991 OVERLAPS_P); \
4992 } \
4993 while (0)
4994
4995
4996 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
4997 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
4998 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
4999 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
5000 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
5001 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
5002 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
5003 x-position of the drawing area. */
5004
5005 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5006 do { \
5007 int cmp_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.cmp_id; \
5008 int face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
5009 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), face_id); \
5010 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
5011 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; \
5012 XChar2b *char2b; \
5013 struct face **faces; \
5014 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
5015 int n; \
5016 \
5017 base_face = base_face->ascii_face; \
5018 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * glyph_len); \
5019 faces = (struct face **) alloca ((sizeof *faces) * glyph_len); \
5020 /* At first, fill in `char2b' and `faces'. */ \
5021 for (n = 0; n < glyph_len; n++) \
5022 { \
5023 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, n); \
5024 int this_face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face, c); \
5025 faces[n] = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), this_face_id); \
5026 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (XFRAME (w->frame), c, \
5027 this_face_id, char2b + n, 1, 1); \
5028 } \
5029 \
5030 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
5031 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
5032 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
5033 { \
5034 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
5035 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b + n, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
5036 x_append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
5037 s->cmp = cmp; \
5038 s->gidx = n; \
5039 s->x = (X); \
5040 \
5041 if (n == 0) \
5042 first_s = s; \
5043 \
5044 n = x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, OVERLAPS_P); \
5045 } \
5046 \
5047 ++START; \
5048 s = first_s; \
5049 } while (0)
5050
5051
5052 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
5053 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
5054 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
5055 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
5056 x-positions of the drawing area.
5057
5058 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
5059 to allocate glyph strings (because x_draw_glyphs can be called
5060 asynchronously). */
5061
5062 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5063 do \
5064 { \
5065 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
5066 while (START < END) \
5067 { \
5068 struct glyph *first_glyph = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA] + START; \
5069 switch (first_glyph->type) \
5070 { \
5071 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
5072 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5073 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, \
5074 OVERLAPS_P); \
5075 break; \
5076 \
5077 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
5078 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5079 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X,\
5080 OVERLAPS_P); \
5081 break; \
5082 \
5083 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
5084 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5085 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5086 break; \
5087 \
5088 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
5089 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5090 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5091 break; \
5092 \
5093 default: \
5094 abort (); \
5095 } \
5096 \
5097 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
5098 (X) += s->width; \
5099 } \
5100 } \
5101 while (0)
5102
5103
5104 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
5105 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
5106 face-override with the following meaning:
5107
5108 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
5109 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
5110 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
5111 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
5112 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
5113 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
5114
5115 If OVERLAPS_P is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters
5116 and clip to the physical height of ROW.
5117
5118 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
5119
5120 static int
5121 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area, start, end, hl, overlaps_p)
5122 struct window *w;
5123 int x;
5124 struct glyph_row *row;
5125 enum glyph_row_area area;
5126 int start, end;
5127 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
5128 int overlaps_p;
5129 {
5130 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
5131 struct glyph_string *s;
5132 int last_x, area_width;
5133 int x_reached;
5134 int i, j;
5135
5136 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
5137 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
5138 start = max (0, start);
5139 start = min (end, start);
5140
5141 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
5142 end of the drawing area. */
5143 if (row->full_width_p)
5144 {
5145 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
5146 or fringes. */
5147 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5148 int window_left_x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (w) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5149
5150 x += window_left_x;
5151 area_width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5152 last_x = window_left_x + area_width;
5153
5154 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5155 {
5156 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5157 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
5158 last_x += width;
5159 else
5160 x -= width;
5161 }
5162
5163 x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5164 last_x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5165 }
5166 else
5167 {
5168 x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, x);
5169 area_width = window_box_width (w, area);
5170 last_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, area_width);
5171 }
5172
5173 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
5174 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
5175 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
5176 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
5177 i = start;
5178 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x,
5179 overlaps_p);
5180 if (tail)
5181 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
5182 else
5183 x_reached = x;
5184
5185 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
5186 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
5187 strings built above. */
5188 if (head && !overlaps_p && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
5189 {
5190 int dummy_x = 0;
5191 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
5192
5193 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
5194 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5195 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
5196
5197 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5198 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
5199 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
5200 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
5201 draws over it. */
5202 i = x_left_overwritten (head);
5203 if (i >= 0)
5204 {
5205 j = i;
5206 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, j, start, h, t,
5207 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5208 overlaps_p);
5209 start = i;
5210 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5211 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5212 }
5213
5214 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5215 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
5216 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
5217 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
5218 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
5219 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
5220 strings exist. */
5221 i = x_left_overwriting (head);
5222 if (i >= 0)
5223 {
5224 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, start, h, t,
5225 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5226 overlaps_p);
5227 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5228 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5229 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5230 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5231 }
5232
5233 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5234 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
5235 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
5236 over it. */
5237 i = x_right_overwritten (tail);
5238 if (i >= 0)
5239 {
5240 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5241 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5242 overlaps_p);
5243 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5244 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5245 }
5246
5247 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5248 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
5249 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
5250 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
5251 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
5252 i = x_right_overwriting (tail);
5253 if (i >= 0)
5254 {
5255 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5256 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5257 overlaps_p);
5258 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5259 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5260 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5261 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5262 }
5263 }
5264
5265 /* Draw all strings. */
5266 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5267 x_draw_glyph_string (s);
5268
5269 if (area == TEXT_AREA
5270 && !row->full_width_p
5271 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
5272 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
5273 completely. */
5274 && !overlaps_p)
5275 {
5276 int x0 = head ? head->x : x;
5277 int x1 = tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x;
5278
5279 x0 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x0);
5280 x1 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x1);
5281
5282 if (XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5283 {
5284 int left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5285 x0 -= left_area_width;
5286 x1 -= left_area_width;
5287 }
5288
5289 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1,
5290 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
5291 }
5292
5293 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
5294 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
5295 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
5296 if (!row->full_width_p)
5297 {
5298 if (area > LEFT_MARGIN_AREA && XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5299 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5300 if (area > TEXT_AREA)
5301 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
5302 }
5303
5304 return x_reached;
5305 }
5306
5307
5308 /* Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W. */
5309
5310 static void
5311 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, area)
5312 struct window *w;
5313 struct glyph_row *row;
5314 enum glyph_row_area area;
5315 {
5316 int i, x;
5317
5318 BLOCK_INPUT;
5319
5320 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5321 x = 0;
5322 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5323 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5324 else
5325 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5326 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5327
5328 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
5329 {
5330 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
5331 {
5332 int start = i, start_x = x;
5333
5334 do
5335 {
5336 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5337 ++i;
5338 }
5339 while (i < row->used[area]
5340 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
5341
5342 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area, start, i,
5343 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 1);
5344 }
5345 else
5346 {
5347 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5348 ++i;
5349 }
5350 }
5351
5352 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5353 }
5354
5355
5356 /* Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
5357 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
5358 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
5359 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
5360 row being updated. */
5361
5362 static void
5363 x_write_glyphs (start, len)
5364 struct glyph *start;
5365 int len;
5366 {
5367 int x, hpos;
5368
5369 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5370 BLOCK_INPUT;
5371
5372 /* Write glyphs. */
5373
5374 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
5375 x = x_draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
5376 updated_row, updated_area,
5377 hpos, hpos + len,
5378 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5379
5380 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
5381 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
5382 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
5383 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
5384 && updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos >= hpos
5385 && updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos < hpos + len)
5386 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
5387
5388 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5389
5390 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5391 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5392 output_cursor.x = x;
5393 }
5394
5395
5396 /* Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
5397
5398 static void
5399 x_insert_glyphs (start, len)
5400 struct glyph *start;
5401 register int len;
5402 {
5403 struct frame *f;
5404 struct window *w;
5405 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
5406 struct glyph_row *row;
5407 struct glyph *glyph;
5408 int frame_x, frame_y, hpos;
5409
5410 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5411 BLOCK_INPUT;
5412 w = updated_window;
5413 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
5414
5415 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
5416 row = updated_row;
5417 line_height = row->height;
5418
5419 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
5420 shift_by_width = 0;
5421 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
5422 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
5423
5424 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
5425 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
5426 - output_cursor.x
5427 - shift_by_width);
5428
5429 /* Shift right. */
5430 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
5431 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
5432 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5433 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5434 frame_x, frame_y,
5435 shifted_region_width, line_height,
5436 frame_x + shift_by_width, frame_y);
5437
5438 /* Write the glyphs. */
5439 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
5440 x_draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area, hpos, hpos + len,
5441 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5442
5443 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5444 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5445 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
5446 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5447 }
5448
5449
5450 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
5451 for X frames. */
5452
5453 static void
5454 x_delete_glyphs (n)
5455 register int n;
5456 {
5457 abort ();
5458 }
5459
5460
5461 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
5462 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
5463
5464 void
5465 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
5466 Display *dpy;
5467 Window window;
5468 int x, y;
5469 int width, height;
5470 int exposures;
5471 {
5472 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
5473 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
5474 }
5475
5476
5477 /* Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
5478 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
5479 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
5480
5481 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
5482 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
5483
5484 static void
5485 x_clear_end_of_line (to_x)
5486 int to_x;
5487 {
5488 struct frame *f;
5489 struct window *w = updated_window;
5490 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
5491 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
5492
5493 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5494 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5495
5496 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5497 {
5498 max_x = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5499 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
5500 && !w->pseudo_window_p)
5501 max_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5502 }
5503 else
5504 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
5505 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5506
5507 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
5508 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
5509 if (to_x == 0)
5510 return;
5511 else if (to_x < 0)
5512 to_x = max_x;
5513 else
5514 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
5515
5516 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
5517
5518 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
5519 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
5520 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
5521 output_cursor.x, -1,
5522 updated_row->y,
5523 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
5524
5525 from_x = output_cursor.x;
5526
5527 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
5528 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5529 {
5530 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
5531 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
5532 }
5533 else
5534 {
5535 from_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, from_x);
5536 to_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, to_x);
5537 }
5538
5539 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5540 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
5541 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
5542
5543 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
5544 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
5545 {
5546 BLOCK_INPUT;
5547 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5548 from_x, from_y, to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y,
5549 False);
5550 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5551 }
5552 }
5553
5554
5555 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
5556 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
5557
5558 static void
5559 x_clear_frame ()
5560 {
5561 struct frame *f;
5562
5563 if (updating_frame)
5564 f = updating_frame;
5565 else
5566 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5567
5568 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
5569 longer visible. */
5570 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
5571 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
5572 output_cursor.x = -1;
5573
5574 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
5575 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
5576 BLOCK_INPUT;
5577 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
5578
5579 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
5580 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
5581 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
5582
5583 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5584 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5585 }
5586
5587
5588 \f
5589 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
5590
5591 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
5592 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
5593
5594 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5595
5596
5597 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
5598 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
5599
5600 static int
5601 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
5602 struct timeval *result, x, y;
5603 {
5604 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
5605 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
5606 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
5607 {
5608 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
5609 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
5610 y.tv_sec += nsec;
5611 }
5612
5613 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
5614 {
5615 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
5616 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
5617 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
5618 }
5619
5620 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
5621 positive. */
5622 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
5623 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
5624
5625 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
5626 negative. */
5627 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
5628 }
5629
5630 void
5631 XTflash (f)
5632 struct frame *f;
5633 {
5634 BLOCK_INPUT;
5635
5636 {
5637 GC gc;
5638
5639 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
5640 pixels into background pixels. */
5641 {
5642 XGCValues values;
5643
5644 values.function = GXxor;
5645 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
5646 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
5647
5648 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5649 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
5650 }
5651
5652 {
5653 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
5654 int height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_HEIGHT (f));
5655 /* Height of each line to flash. */
5656 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
5657 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
5658 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5659 int flash_right = PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5660
5661 int width;
5662
5663 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
5664 edge it is next to. */
5665 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
5666 {
5667 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
5668 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5669 break;
5670
5671 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
5672 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5673 break;
5674
5675 default:
5676 break;
5677 }
5678
5679 width = flash_right - flash_left;
5680
5681 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5682 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5683 {
5684 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5685 flash_left,
5686 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5687 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5688 width, flash_height);
5689 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5690 flash_left,
5691 (height - flash_height
5692 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5693 width, flash_height);
5694 }
5695 else
5696 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5697 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5698 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5699 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5700
5701 x_flush (f);
5702
5703 {
5704 struct timeval wakeup;
5705
5706 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
5707
5708 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
5709 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
5710 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
5711 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
5712
5713 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
5714 available. */
5715 while (! detect_input_pending ())
5716 {
5717 struct timeval current;
5718 struct timeval timeout;
5719
5720 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
5721
5722 /* Break if result would be negative. */
5723 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
5724 break;
5725
5726 /* How long `select' should wait. */
5727 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
5728 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
5729
5730 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
5731 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
5732 }
5733 }
5734
5735 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5736 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5737 {
5738 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5739 flash_left,
5740 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5741 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5742 width, flash_height);
5743 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5744 flash_left,
5745 (height - flash_height
5746 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5747 width, flash_height);
5748 }
5749 else
5750 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5751 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5752 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5753 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5754
5755 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
5756 x_flush (f);
5757 }
5758 }
5759
5760 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5761 }
5762
5763 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
5764
5765
5766 /* Make audible bell. */
5767
5768 void
5769 XTring_bell ()
5770 {
5771 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5772
5773 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
5774 {
5775 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5776 if (visible_bell)
5777 XTflash (f);
5778 else
5779 #endif
5780 {
5781 BLOCK_INPUT;
5782 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
5783 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5784 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5785 }
5786 }
5787 }
5788
5789 \f
5790 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
5791 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
5792 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
5793 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
5794
5795 static void
5796 XTset_terminal_window (n)
5797 register int n;
5798 {
5799 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
5800 }
5801
5802
5803 \f
5804 /***********************************************************************
5805 Line Dance
5806 ***********************************************************************/
5807
5808 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
5809 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
5810
5811 static void
5812 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
5813 int vpos, n;
5814 {
5815 abort ();
5816 }
5817
5818
5819 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
5820
5821 static void
5822 x_scroll_run (w, run)
5823 struct window *w;
5824 struct run *run;
5825 {
5826 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5827 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
5828
5829 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
5830 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
5831 fringe of W. */
5832 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
5833 width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5834 x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5835
5836 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
5837 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
5838 bottom_y = y + height;
5839
5840 if (to_y < from_y)
5841 {
5842 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
5843 line at the bottom. */
5844 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5845 height = bottom_y - from_y;
5846 else
5847 height = run->height;
5848 }
5849 else
5850 {
5851 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
5852 at the bottom. */
5853 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5854 height = bottom_y - to_y;
5855 else
5856 height = run->height;
5857 }
5858
5859 BLOCK_INPUT;
5860
5861 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
5862 updated_window = w;
5863 x_clear_cursor (w);
5864
5865 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5866 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5867 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5868 x, from_y,
5869 width, height,
5870 x, to_y);
5871
5872 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5873 }
5874
5875
5876 \f
5877 /***********************************************************************
5878 Exposure Events
5879 ***********************************************************************/
5880
5881 /* Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
5882 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
5883 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
5884 the entire frame. */
5885
5886 static void
5887 expose_frame (f, x, y, w, h)
5888 struct frame *f;
5889 int x, y, w, h;
5890 {
5891 XRectangle r;
5892 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5893
5894 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
5895
5896 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
5897 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5898 {
5899 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
5900 return;
5901 }
5902
5903 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
5904 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
5905 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
5906 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
5907 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
5908 {
5909 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
5910 return;
5911 }
5912
5913 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
5914 {
5915 r.x = r.y = 0;
5916 r.width = CANON_X_UNIT (f) * f->width;
5917 r.height = CANON_Y_UNIT (f) * f->height;
5918 }
5919 else
5920 {
5921 r.x = x;
5922 r.y = y;
5923 r.width = w;
5924 r.height = h;
5925 }
5926
5927 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
5928 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
5929
5930 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
5931 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5932 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
5933
5934 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5935 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
5936 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5937 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
5938 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5939
5940 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
5941 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
5942 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
5943 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
5944 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
5945 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
5946 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
5947 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
5948 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
5949 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
5950 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5951 {
5952 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
5953 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
5954 {
5955 int x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
5956 int y = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
5957 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
5958 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y);
5959 }
5960 }
5961 }
5962
5963
5964 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
5965 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
5966 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
5967
5968 static int
5969 expose_window_tree (w, r)
5970 struct window *w;
5971 XRectangle *r;
5972 {
5973 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5974 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5975
5976 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5977 {
5978 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
5979 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5980 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
5981 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
5982 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5983 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
5984 else
5985 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
5986
5987 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
5988 }
5989
5990 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
5991 }
5992
5993
5994 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
5995 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5996
5997 static void
5998 expose_area (w, row, r, area)
5999 struct window *w;
6000 struct glyph_row *row;
6001 XRectangle *r;
6002 enum glyph_row_area area;
6003 {
6004 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
6005 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
6006 struct glyph *last;
6007 int first_x, start_x, x;
6008
6009 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
6010 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
6011 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area, 0, row->used[area],
6012 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
6013 else
6014 {
6015 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
6016 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
6017 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
6018 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
6019 start_x = 0;
6020 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
6021 start_x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6022 else
6023 start_x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
6024 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
6025 x = start_x;
6026
6027 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
6028 while (first < end
6029 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
6030 {
6031 x += first->pixel_width;
6032 ++first;
6033 }
6034
6035 /* Find the last one. */
6036 last = first;
6037 first_x = x;
6038 while (last < end
6039 && x < r->x + r->width)
6040 {
6041 x += last->pixel_width;
6042 ++last;
6043 }
6044
6045 /* Repaint. */
6046 if (last > first)
6047 x_draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
6048 first - row->glyphs[area],
6049 last - row->glyphs[area],
6050 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
6051 }
6052 }
6053
6054
6055 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
6056 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
6057 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
6058
6059 static int
6060 expose_line (w, row, r)
6061 struct window *w;
6062 struct glyph_row *row;
6063 XRectangle *r;
6064 {
6065 xassert (row->enabled_p);
6066
6067 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
6068 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA, 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
6069 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
6070 else
6071 {
6072 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
6073 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6074 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
6075 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
6076 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
6077 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
6078 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
6079 }
6080
6081 return row->mouse_face_p;
6082 }
6083
6084
6085 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
6086
6087 static int
6088 x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r)
6089 struct window *w;
6090 XRectangle *r;
6091 {
6092 XRectangle cr, result;
6093 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
6094
6095 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
6096 if (cursor_glyph)
6097 {
6098 cr.x = w->phys_cursor.x;
6099 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
6100 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
6101 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
6102 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
6103 }
6104 else
6105 return 0;
6106 }
6107
6108
6109 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
6110 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
6111 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
6112
6113 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
6114 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
6115 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
6116
6117 static void
6118 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row)
6119 struct window *w;
6120 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row;
6121 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row;
6122 {
6123 struct glyph_row *row;
6124
6125 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
6126 if (row->overlapping_p)
6127 {
6128 xassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
6129
6130 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
6131 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6132
6133 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
6134 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA);
6135
6136 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
6137 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
6138 }
6139 }
6140
6141
6142 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
6143 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
6144 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
6145 mouse-face. */
6146
6147 static int
6148 expose_window (w, fr)
6149 struct window *w;
6150 XRectangle *fr;
6151 {
6152 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6153 XRectangle wr, r;
6154 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
6155
6156 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
6157 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
6158 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
6159 created window. */
6160 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
6161 return 0;
6162
6163 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
6164 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
6165 later. */
6166 if (w == updated_window)
6167 {
6168 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6169 return 0;
6170 }
6171
6172 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
6173 wr.x = XFASTINT (w->left) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6174 wr.y = XFASTINT (w->top) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6175 wr.width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6176 wr.height = XFASTINT (w->height) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6177
6178 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
6179 {
6180 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
6181 struct glyph_row *row;
6182 int cursor_cleared_p;
6183 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
6184
6185 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
6186 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
6187
6188 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
6189 r.x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r.x);
6190 r.y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r.y);
6191
6192 /* Turn off the cursor. */
6193 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
6194 && x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
6195 {
6196 x_clear_cursor (w);
6197 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
6198 }
6199 else
6200 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
6201
6202 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
6203 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
6204 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
6205 row->enabled_p;
6206 ++row)
6207 {
6208 int y0 = row->y;
6209 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
6210
6211 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
6212 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
6213 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
6214 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
6215 {
6216 if (row->overlapping_p)
6217 {
6218 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
6219 first_overlapping_row = row;
6220 last_overlapping_row = row;
6221 }
6222
6223 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6224 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6225 }
6226
6227 if (y1 >= yb)
6228 break;
6229 }
6230
6231 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
6232 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
6233 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
6234 row->enabled_p)
6235 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
6236 {
6237 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6238 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6239 }
6240
6241 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
6242 {
6243 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
6244 if (first_overlapping_row)
6245 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row);
6246
6247 /* Draw border between windows. */
6248 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
6249
6250 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
6251 if (cursor_cleared_p)
6252 x_update_window_cursor (w, 1);
6253 }
6254 }
6255
6256 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
6257 }
6258
6259
6260 /* Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
6261 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
6262 empty. */
6263
6264 static int
6265 x_intersect_rectangles (r1, r2, result)
6266 XRectangle *r1, *r2, *result;
6267 {
6268 XRectangle *left, *right;
6269 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
6270 int intersection_p = 0;
6271
6272 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
6273 if (r1->x < r2->x)
6274 left = r1, right = r2;
6275 else
6276 left = r2, right = r1;
6277
6278 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
6279 otherwise there is no intersection. */
6280 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
6281 {
6282 result->x = right->x;
6283
6284 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of the
6285 the right ends of left and right. */
6286 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
6287 - result->x);
6288
6289 /* Same game for Y. */
6290 if (r1->y < r2->y)
6291 upper = r1, lower = r2;
6292 else
6293 upper = r2, lower = r1;
6294
6295 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
6296 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
6297 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
6298 {
6299 result->y = lower->y;
6300
6301 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
6302 ends of upper and lower. */
6303 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
6304 upper->y + upper->height)
6305 - result->y);
6306 intersection_p = 1;
6307 }
6308 }
6309
6310 return intersection_p;
6311 }
6312
6313
6314
6315
6316 \f
6317 static void
6318 frame_highlight (f)
6319 struct frame *f;
6320 {
6321 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6322 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6323 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6324 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6325 BLOCK_INPUT;
6326 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6327 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
6328 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6329 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6330 }
6331
6332 static void
6333 frame_unhighlight (f)
6334 struct frame *f;
6335 {
6336 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6337 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6338 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6339 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6340 BLOCK_INPUT;
6341 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6342 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
6343 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6344 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6345 }
6346
6347 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
6348 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
6349 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
6350 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
6351 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
6352
6353 static void
6354 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
6355 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6356 struct frame *frame;
6357 {
6358 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6359
6360 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6361 {
6362 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
6363 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
6364 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
6365
6366 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
6367 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
6368
6369 #if 0
6370 selected_frame = frame;
6371 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
6372 selected_frame);
6373 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window);
6374 choose_minibuf_frame ();
6375 #endif /* ! 0 */
6376
6377 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
6378 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6379 else
6380 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
6381 }
6382
6383 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
6384 }
6385
6386 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
6387 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
6388 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into BUFP.
6389 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
6390
6391 static int
6392 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp, numchars)
6393 int type;
6394 int state;
6395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6396 struct frame *frame;
6397 struct input_event *bufp;
6398 int numchars;
6399 {
6400 int nr_events = 0;
6401
6402 if (type == FocusIn)
6403 {
6404 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
6405 {
6406 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
6407 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
6408
6409 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
6410 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
6411 if (numchars > 0
6412 && GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
6413 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
6414 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6415 {
6416 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
6417 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
6418 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6419 ++bufp;
6420 numchars--;
6421 ++nr_events;
6422 }
6423 }
6424
6425 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
6426
6427 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6428 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
6429 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
6430 #endif
6431 }
6432 else if (type == FocusOut)
6433 {
6434 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
6435
6436 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
6437 {
6438 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
6439 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6440 }
6441
6442 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6443 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
6444 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
6445 #endif
6446 }
6447
6448 return nr_events;
6449 }
6450
6451 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
6452 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
6453
6454 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
6455
6456 static int
6457 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp, numchars)
6458 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6459 XEvent *event;
6460 struct input_event *bufp;
6461 int numchars;
6462 {
6463 struct frame *frame;
6464 int nr_events = 0;
6465
6466 frame = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
6467 if (! frame) return nr_events;
6468
6469 switch (event->type)
6470 {
6471 case EnterNotify:
6472 case LeaveNotify:
6473 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
6474 && event->xcrossing.focus
6475 && ! (frame->output_data.x->focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
6476 nr_events = x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify
6477 ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
6478 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
6479 dpyinfo,
6480 frame,
6481 bufp,
6482 numchars);
6483 break;
6484
6485 case FocusIn:
6486 case FocusOut:
6487 nr_events = x_focus_changed (event->type,
6488 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer
6489 ? FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
6490 dpyinfo,
6491 frame,
6492 bufp,
6493 numchars);
6494 break;
6495 }
6496
6497 return nr_events;
6498 }
6499
6500
6501 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
6502
6503 void
6504 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
6505 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6506 {
6507 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
6508 }
6509
6510 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
6511 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
6512 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
6513
6514 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
6515 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
6516 the appropriate X display info. */
6517
6518 static void
6519 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
6520 struct frame *frame;
6521 {
6522 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
6523 }
6524
6525 static void
6526 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
6527 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6528 {
6529 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
6530
6531 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6532 {
6533 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
6534 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
6535 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
6536 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
6537 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
6538 {
6539 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
6540 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6541 }
6542 }
6543 else
6544 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
6545
6546 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
6547 {
6548 if (old_highlight)
6549 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
6550 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
6551 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
6552 }
6553 }
6554
6555
6556 \f
6557 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
6558
6559 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
6560 static void
6561 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
6562 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6563 {
6564 int min_code, max_code;
6565 KeySym *syms;
6566 int syms_per_code;
6567 XModifierKeymap *mods;
6568
6569 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
6570 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
6571 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6572 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
6573 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
6574
6575 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
6576 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
6577 #else
6578 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
6579 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
6580 #endif
6581
6582 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
6583 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
6584 &syms_per_code);
6585 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
6586
6587 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
6588 Alt keysyms are on. */
6589 {
6590 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
6591
6592 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
6593 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
6594 {
6595 KeyCode code
6596 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
6597
6598 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
6599 if (code == 0)
6600 continue;
6601
6602 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
6603 {
6604 int code_col;
6605
6606 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
6607 {
6608 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
6609
6610 switch (sym)
6611 {
6612 case XK_Meta_L:
6613 case XK_Meta_R:
6614 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6615 break;
6616
6617 case XK_Alt_L:
6618 case XK_Alt_R:
6619 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6620 break;
6621
6622 case XK_Hyper_L:
6623 case XK_Hyper_R:
6624 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6625 break;
6626
6627 case XK_Super_L:
6628 case XK_Super_R:
6629 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6630 break;
6631
6632 case XK_Shift_Lock:
6633 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
6634 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
6635 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
6636 break;
6637 }
6638 }
6639 }
6640 }
6641 }
6642
6643 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
6644 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6645 {
6646 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
6647 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6648 }
6649
6650 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
6651 make them just meta, not alt. */
6652 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6653 {
6654 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
6655 }
6656
6657 XFree ((char *) syms);
6658 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
6659 }
6660
6661 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
6662 Emacs uses. */
6663
6664 static unsigned int
6665 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6666 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6667 unsigned int state;
6668 {
6669 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6670 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6671 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6672 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6673 Lisp_Object tem;
6674
6675 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6676 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6677 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6678 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6679 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6680 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6681 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6682 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6683
6684
6685 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
6686 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
6687 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
6688 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
6689 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
6690 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
6691 }
6692
6693 static unsigned int
6694 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6695 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6696 unsigned int state;
6697 {
6698 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6699 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6700 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6701 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6702
6703 Lisp_Object tem;
6704
6705 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6706 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6707 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6708 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6709 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6710 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6711 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6712 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6713
6714
6715 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
6716 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
6717 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
6718 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
6719 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
6720 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
6721 }
6722
6723 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
6724
6725 char *
6726 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
6727 KeySym keysym;
6728 {
6729 char *value;
6730
6731 BLOCK_INPUT;
6732 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
6733 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6734
6735 return value;
6736 }
6737
6738
6739 \f
6740 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
6741
6742 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
6743 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
6744 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
6745 not force the value into range. */
6746
6747 void
6748 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, pix_x, pix_y, x, y, bounds, noclip)
6749 FRAME_PTR f;
6750 register int pix_x, pix_y;
6751 register int *x, *y;
6752 XRectangle *bounds;
6753 int noclip;
6754 {
6755 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to round down
6756 even for negative values. */
6757 if (pix_x < 0)
6758 pix_x -= FONT_WIDTH ((f)->output_data.x->font) - 1;
6759 if (pix_y < 0)
6760 pix_y -= (f)->output_data.x->line_height - 1;
6761
6762 pix_x = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL (f, pix_x);
6763 pix_y = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_ROW (f, pix_y);
6764
6765 if (bounds)
6766 {
6767 bounds->width = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
6768 bounds->height = f->output_data.x->line_height;
6769 bounds->x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, pix_x);
6770 bounds->y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, pix_y);
6771 }
6772
6773 if (!noclip)
6774 {
6775 if (pix_x < 0)
6776 pix_x = 0;
6777 else if (pix_x > FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f))
6778 pix_x = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f);
6779
6780 if (pix_y < 0)
6781 pix_y = 0;
6782 else if (pix_y > f->height)
6783 pix_y = f->height;
6784 }
6785
6786 *x = pix_x;
6787 *y = pix_y;
6788 }
6789
6790
6791 /* Given HPOS/VPOS in the current matrix of W, return corresponding
6792 frame-relative pixel positions in *FRAME_X and *FRAME_Y. If we
6793 can't tell the positions because W's display is not up to date,
6794 return 0. */
6795
6796 int
6797 glyph_to_pixel_coords (w, hpos, vpos, frame_x, frame_y)
6798 struct window *w;
6799 int hpos, vpos;
6800 int *frame_x, *frame_y;
6801 {
6802 int success_p;
6803
6804 xassert (hpos >= 0 && hpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_w);
6805 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_h);
6806
6807 if (display_completed)
6808 {
6809 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
6810 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6811 struct glyph *end = glyph + min (hpos, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
6812
6813 *frame_y = row->y;
6814 *frame_x = row->x;
6815 while (glyph < end)
6816 {
6817 *frame_x += glyph->pixel_width;
6818 ++glyph;
6819 }
6820
6821 success_p = 1;
6822 }
6823 else
6824 {
6825 *frame_y = *frame_x = 0;
6826 success_p = 0;
6827 }
6828
6829 *frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, *frame_y);
6830 *frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, *frame_x);
6831 return success_p;
6832 }
6833
6834
6835 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
6836
6837 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
6838 the mouse. */
6839
6840 static Lisp_Object
6841 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
6842 struct input_event *result;
6843 XButtonEvent *event;
6844 struct frame *f;
6845 {
6846 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
6847 otherwise. */
6848 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
6849 result->code = event->button - Button1;
6850 result->timestamp = event->time;
6851 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6852 event->state)
6853 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6854 ? up_modifier
6855 : down_modifier));
6856
6857 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
6858 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
6859 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
6860 result->arg = Qnil;
6861 return Qnil;
6862 }
6863
6864 \f
6865 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
6866 The input handler calls this.
6867
6868 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
6869 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
6870 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
6871 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
6872
6873 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
6874 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
6875
6876 static void
6877 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
6878 FRAME_PTR frame;
6879 XMotionEvent *event;
6880 {
6881 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6882 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
6883 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
6884
6885 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
6886 {
6887 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6888 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6889 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
6890 }
6891
6892 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
6893 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
6894 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
6895 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
6896 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
6897 {
6898 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6899 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6900 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
6901 }
6902 }
6903
6904 \f
6905 /************************************************************************
6906 Mouse Face
6907 ************************************************************************/
6908
6909 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
6910 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
6911 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
6912 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
6913 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
6914 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
6915 date. */
6916
6917 static struct glyph *
6918 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, area, buffer_only_p)
6919 struct window *w;
6920 int x, y;
6921 int *hpos, *vpos, *area;
6922 int buffer_only_p;
6923 {
6924 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6925 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
6926 int x0, i, left_area_width;
6927
6928 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
6929 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
6930 {
6931 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
6932 if (!row->enabled_p)
6933 return NULL;
6934 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
6935 break;
6936 }
6937
6938 *vpos = i;
6939 *hpos = 0;
6940
6941 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
6942 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
6943 return NULL;
6944
6945 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
6946 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6947 {
6948 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6949 x0 = 0;
6950 }
6951 else
6952 {
6953 left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6954 if (x < left_area_width)
6955 {
6956 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
6957 x0 = 0;
6958 }
6959 else if (x < left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA))
6960 {
6961 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6962 x0 = row->x + left_area_width;
6963 }
6964 else
6965 {
6966 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
6967 x0 = left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
6968 }
6969 }
6970
6971 /* Find glyph containing X. */
6972 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
6973 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
6974 while (glyph < end)
6975 {
6976 if (x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6977 {
6978 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6979 break;
6980 else if (!buffer_only_p || BUFFERP (glyph->object))
6981 break;
6982 }
6983
6984 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6985 ++glyph;
6986 }
6987
6988 if (glyph == end)
6989 return NULL;
6990
6991 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
6992 return glyph;
6993 }
6994
6995
6996 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
6997 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
6998
6999 static void
7000 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, x, y)
7001 struct window *w;
7002 int *x, *y;
7003 {
7004 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
7005 {
7006 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
7007 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
7008 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7009 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH_SAFE (f);
7010 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
7011 }
7012 else
7013 {
7014 *x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, *x);
7015 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
7016 }
7017 }
7018
7019
7020 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
7021 or marginal area of window W, x-position X and y-position Y. Area
7022 is 1, 3, 6 or 7 for the mode line, header line, left and right
7023 marginal area respectively. X is relative to the start of the text
7024 display area of W, so the width of bitmap areas and scroll bars
7025 must be subtracted to get a position relative to the start of the
7026 mode line. */
7027
7028 static void
7029 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion)
7030 struct window *w;
7031 int x, y, portion;
7032 {
7033 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7034 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7035 Cursor cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
7036 int charpos;
7037 Lisp_Object string, help, map, pos;
7038
7039 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3)
7040 string = mode_line_string (w, x, y, portion == 1, &charpos);
7041 else
7042 string = marginal_area_string (w, x, y, portion, &charpos);
7043
7044 if (STRINGP (string))
7045 {
7046 pos = make_number (charpos);
7047
7048 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property, arrange
7049 for the help to be displayed. This is done by setting the
7050 global variable help_echo to the help string. */
7051 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
7052 if (!NILP (help))
7053 {
7054 help_echo = help;
7055 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
7056 help_echo_object = string;
7057 help_echo_pos = charpos;
7058 }
7059
7060 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
7061 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
7062 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
7063 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
7064 if (KEYMAPP (map))
7065 cursor = f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor;
7066 }
7067
7068 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7069 }
7070
7071
7072 /* Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
7073 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
7074 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
7075 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
7076
7077 static void
7078 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y)
7079 struct frame *f;
7080 int x, y;
7081 {
7082 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7083 int portion;
7084 Lisp_Object window;
7085 struct window *w;
7086 Cursor cursor = None;
7087 struct buffer *b;
7088
7089 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
7090 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7091 if (popup_activated ())
7092 return;
7093 #endif
7094
7095 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
7096 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
7097 return;
7098
7099 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
7100 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
7101 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
7102
7103 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer)
7104 return;
7105
7106 if (gc_in_progress)
7107 {
7108 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
7109 return;
7110 }
7111
7112 /* Which window is that in? */
7113 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &portion, 1);
7114
7115 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
7116 if (! EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7117 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7118
7119 /* Not on a window -> return. */
7120 if (!WINDOWP (window))
7121 return;
7122
7123 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
7124 w = XWINDOW (window);
7125 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7126
7127 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
7128 buffer. */
7129 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
7130 {
7131 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
7132 return;
7133 }
7134
7135 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
7136 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3 || portion == 6 || portion == 7)
7137 {
7138 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion);
7139 return;
7140 }
7141
7142 if (portion == 2)
7143 cursor = f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor;
7144 else
7145 cursor = f->output_data.x->text_cursor;
7146
7147 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
7148 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
7149 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
7150 if (/* Within text portion of the window. */
7151 portion == 0
7152 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
7153 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (b)
7154 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
7155 {
7156 int hpos, vpos, pos, i, area;
7157 struct glyph *glyph;
7158 Lisp_Object object;
7159 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, overlay = Qnil, position;
7160 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
7161 int len, noverlays;
7162 struct buffer *obuf;
7163 int obegv, ozv, same_region;
7164
7165 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
7166 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &area, 0);
7167
7168 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
7169 if (glyph == NULL
7170 || area != TEXT_AREA
7171 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p)
7172 {
7173 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
7174 cursor = None;
7175 goto set_cursor;
7176 }
7177
7178 pos = glyph->charpos;
7179 object = glyph->object;
7180 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
7181 goto set_cursor;
7182
7183 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
7184 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
7185 goto set_cursor;
7186
7187 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
7188 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
7189 obuf = current_buffer;
7190 current_buffer = b;
7191 obegv = BEGV;
7192 ozv = ZV;
7193 BEGV = BEG;
7194 ZV = Z;
7195
7196 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
7197 position = make_number (pos);
7198
7199 if (BUFFERP (object))
7200 {
7201 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec.
7202 Store the length in len. If there are more than 10, make
7203 enough space for all, and try again. */
7204 len = 10;
7205 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
7206 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL, 0);
7207 if (noverlays > len)
7208 {
7209 len = noverlays;
7210 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
7211 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL,0);
7212 }
7213
7214 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
7215 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
7216 }
7217 else
7218 noverlays = 0;
7219
7220 same_region = (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
7221 && vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7222 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7223 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7224 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7225 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7226 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7227 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end));
7228
7229 if (same_region)
7230 cursor = None;
7231
7232 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
7233 if (! same_region
7234 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
7235 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
7236 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
7237 highlight only that. */
7238 || (OVERLAYP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
7239 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
7240 {
7241 /* Find the highest priority overlay that has a mouse-face
7242 property. */
7243 overlay = Qnil;
7244 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
7245 {
7246 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
7247 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
7248 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7249 }
7250
7251 /* If we're actually highlighting the same overlay as
7252 before, there's no need to do that again. */
7253 if (!NILP (overlay)
7254 && EQ (overlay, dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
7255 goto check_help_echo;
7256
7257 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
7258
7259 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
7260 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
7261 cursor = None;
7262
7263 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
7264 if (NILP (overlay))
7265 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
7266
7267 /* Handle the overlay case. */
7268 if (!NILP (overlay))
7269 {
7270 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7271 should be active. */
7272 Lisp_Object before, after;
7273 int ignore;
7274
7275 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7276 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7277 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7278 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7279 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7280 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7281 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7282 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7283
7284 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7285 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7286 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7287 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7288 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7289 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7290 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7291 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7292 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7293 &ignore, pos + 1,
7294 !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden);
7295
7296 /* Display it as active. */
7297 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7298 cursor = None;
7299 }
7300 /* Handle the text property case. */
7301 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && BUFFERP (object))
7302 {
7303 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7304 should be active. */
7305 Lisp_Object before, after, beginning, end;
7306 int ignore;
7307
7308 beginning = Fmarker_position (w->start);
7309 end = make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (object))
7310 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos));
7311 before
7312 = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7313 Qmouse_face,
7314 object, beginning);
7315 after
7316 = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7317 object, end);
7318
7319 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7320 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7321 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7322 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7323 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7324 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7326 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7327 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7328 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7329 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7330 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7332
7333 if (BUFFERP (object))
7334 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7335 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7336 &ignore, pos + 1,
7337 !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden);
7338
7339 /* Display it as active. */
7340 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7341 cursor = None;
7342 }
7343 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
7344 {
7345 Lisp_Object b, e;
7346 int ignore;
7347
7348 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7349 Qmouse_face,
7350 object, Qnil);
7351 e = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7352 object, Qnil);
7353 if (NILP (b))
7354 b = make_number (0);
7355 if (NILP (e))
7356 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
7357 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (b), object,
7358 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7359 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7360 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7361 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, 0);
7362 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (e), object,
7363 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7364 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7365 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7366 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, 1);
7367 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7368 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7369 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7370 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
7371 glyph->face_id, 1);
7372 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7373 cursor = None;
7374 }
7375 else if (STRINGP (object) && NILP (mouse_face))
7376 {
7377 /* A string which doesn't have mouse-face, but
7378 the text ``under'' it might have. */
7379 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7380 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7381
7382 pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7383 if (pos > 0)
7384 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (pos),
7385 Qmouse_face,
7386 w->buffer,
7387 &overlay);
7388 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && !NILP (overlay))
7389 {
7390 Lisp_Object before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7391 Lisp_Object after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7392 int ignore;
7393
7394 /* Note that we might not be able to find position
7395 BEFORE in the glyph matrix if the overlay is
7396 entirely covered by a `display' property. In
7397 this case, we overshoot. So let's stop in
7398 the glyph matrix before glyphs for OBJECT. */
7399 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7400 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7401 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7402 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7403 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y,
7404 object);
7405
7406 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7407 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7408 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7409 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7410 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7411 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y,
7412 Qnil);
7413 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7414 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7415 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7416 &ignore, pos + 1,
7417 !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden);
7418
7419 /* Display it as active. */
7420 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7421 cursor = None;
7422 }
7423 }
7424 }
7425
7426 check_help_echo:
7427
7428 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
7429 {
7430 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
7431
7432 /* Check overlays first. */
7433 help = overlay = Qnil;
7434 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
7435 {
7436 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7437 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
7438 }
7439
7440 if (!NILP (help))
7441 {
7442 help_echo = help;
7443 help_echo_window = window;
7444 help_echo_object = overlay;
7445 help_echo_pos = pos;
7446 }
7447 else
7448 {
7449 Lisp_Object object = glyph->object;
7450 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7451
7452 /* Try text properties. */
7453 if (STRINGP (object)
7454 && charpos >= 0
7455 && charpos < SCHARS (object))
7456 {
7457 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
7458 Qhelp_echo, object);
7459 if (NILP (help))
7460 {
7461 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
7462 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
7463 struct glyph_row *r
7464 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7465 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7466 int pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7467 if (pos > 0)
7468 {
7469 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (pos),
7470 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
7471 if (!NILP (help))
7472 {
7473 charpos = pos;
7474 object = w->buffer;
7475 }
7476 }
7477 }
7478 }
7479 else if (BUFFERP (object)
7480 && charpos >= BEGV
7481 && charpos < ZV)
7482 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
7483 object);
7484
7485 if (!NILP (help))
7486 {
7487 help_echo = help;
7488 help_echo_window = window;
7489 help_echo_object = object;
7490 help_echo_pos = charpos;
7491 }
7492 }
7493 }
7494
7495 BEGV = obegv;
7496 ZV = ozv;
7497 current_buffer = obuf;
7498 }
7499
7500 set_cursor:
7501
7502 if (cursor != None)
7503 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7504 }
7505
7506 static void
7507 redo_mouse_highlight ()
7508 {
7509 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
7510 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
7511 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
7512 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
7513 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
7514 }
7515
7516
7517 \f
7518 /***********************************************************************
7519 Tool-bars
7520 ***********************************************************************/
7521
7522 static int x_tool_bar_item P_ ((struct frame *, int, int,
7523 struct glyph **, int *, int *, int *));
7524
7525 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
7526 or -1. */
7527
7528 static int last_tool_bar_item;
7529
7530
7531 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
7532 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
7533 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
7534 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
7535 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
7536
7537 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
7538 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
7539 1 otherwise. */
7540
7541 static int
7542 x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, glyph, hpos, vpos, prop_idx)
7543 struct frame *f;
7544 int x, y;
7545 struct glyph **glyph;
7546 int *hpos, *vpos, *prop_idx;
7547 {
7548 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7549 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7550 int area;
7551
7552 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
7553 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, &area, 0);
7554 if (*glyph == NULL)
7555 return -1;
7556
7557 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
7558 f->tool_bar_items. */
7559 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
7560 return -1;
7561
7562 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
7563 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
7564 && *vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7565 && *vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7566 && (*vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7567 || *hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7568 && (*vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7569 || *hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7570 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
7571 return 0;
7572
7573 return 1;
7574 }
7575
7576
7577 /* Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
7578 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. EVENT_TYPE is either ButtonPress
7579 or ButtonRelase. */
7580
7581 static void
7582 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, button_event)
7583 struct frame *f;
7584 XButtonEvent *button_event;
7585 {
7586 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7587 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7588 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
7589 struct glyph *glyph;
7590 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7591 int x = button_event->x;
7592 int y = button_event->y;
7593
7594 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
7595 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7596 if (x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
7597 return;
7598
7599 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
7600 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7601 if (NILP (enabled_p))
7602 return;
7603
7604 if (button_event->type == ButtonPress)
7605 {
7606 /* Show item in pressed state. */
7607 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
7608 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
7609 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
7610 }
7611 else
7612 {
7613 Lisp_Object key, frame;
7614 struct input_event event;
7615
7616 /* Show item in released state. */
7617 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
7618 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7619
7620 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
7621
7622 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7623 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7624 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7625 event.arg = frame;
7626 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7627
7628 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7629 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7630 event.arg = key;
7631 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7632 button_event->state);
7633 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7634 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7635 }
7636 }
7637
7638
7639 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
7640 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
7641 note_mouse_highlight. */
7642
7643 static void
7644 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y)
7645 struct frame *f;
7646 int x, y;
7647 {
7648 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
7649 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7650 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7651 int hpos, vpos;
7652 struct glyph *glyph;
7653 struct glyph_row *row;
7654 int i;
7655 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7656 int prop_idx;
7657 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7658 int mouse_down_p, rc;
7659
7660 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative x(y
7661 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
7662 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
7663 {
7664 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7665 return;
7666 }
7667
7668 rc = x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
7669 if (rc < 0)
7670 {
7671 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
7672 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7673 return;
7674 }
7675 else if (rc == 0)
7676 goto set_help_echo;
7677
7678 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7679
7680 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
7681 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
7682 && f == last_mouse_frame
7683 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
7684 if (mouse_down_p
7685 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
7686 return;
7687
7688 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
7689 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7690
7691 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
7692 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7693 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
7694 {
7695 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
7696 image is a space. We include this is the highlighted area. */
7697 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7698 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
7699 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
7700
7701 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7702 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
7703 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
7704 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
7705 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
7706 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7707
7708 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
7709 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
7710 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
7711 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
7712 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7713 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
7714
7715 /* Display it as active. */
7716 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw);
7717 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
7718 }
7719
7720 set_help_echo:
7721
7722 /* Set help_echo to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
7723 XTread_socket does the rest. */
7724 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
7725 help_echo_pos = -1;
7726 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
7727 if (NILP (help_echo))
7728 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
7729 }
7730
7731
7732 \f
7733 /* Find the glyph matrix position of buffer position CHARPOS in window
7734 *W. HPOS, *VPOS, *X, and *Y are set to the positions found. W's
7735 current glyphs must be up to date. If CHARPOS is above window
7736 start return (0, 0, 0, 0). If CHARPOS is after end of W, return end
7737 of last line in W. In the row containing CHARPOS, stop before glyphs
7738 having STOP as object. */
7739
7740 #if 0 /* This is a version of fast_find_position that's more correct
7741 in the presence of hscrolling, for example. I didn't install
7742 it right away because the problem fixed is minor, it failed
7743 in 20.x as well, and I think it's too risky to install
7744 so near the release of 21.1. 2001-09-25 gerd. */
7745
7746 static int
7747 fast_find_position (w, charpos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7748 struct window *w;
7749 int charpos;
7750 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7751 Lisp_Object stop;
7752 {
7753 struct glyph_row *row, *first;
7754 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
7755 int i, past_end = 0;
7756
7757 first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7758 row = row_containing_pos (w, charpos, first, NULL, 0);
7759 if (row == NULL)
7760 {
7761 if (charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first))
7762 {
7763 *x = *y = *hpos = *vpos = 0;
7764 return 0;
7765 }
7766 else
7767 {
7768 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
7769 past_end = 1;
7770 }
7771 }
7772
7773 *x = row->x;
7774 *y = row->y;
7775 *vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7776
7777 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7778 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7779
7780 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start of the row.
7781 These are special glyphs like truncation marks on terminal
7782 frames. */
7783 if (row->displays_text_p)
7784 while (glyph < end
7785 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7786 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7787 && glyph->charpos < 0)
7788 {
7789 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7790 ++glyph;
7791 }
7792
7793 while (glyph < end
7794 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7795 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7796 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
7797 || glyph->charpos < charpos))
7798 {
7799 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7800 ++glyph;
7801 }
7802
7803 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7804 return past_end;
7805 }
7806
7807 #else /* not 0 */
7808
7809 static int
7810 fast_find_position (w, pos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7811 struct window *w;
7812 int pos;
7813 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7814 Lisp_Object stop;
7815 {
7816 int i;
7817 int lastcol;
7818 int maybe_next_line_p = 0;
7819 int line_start_position;
7820 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7821 struct glyph_row *row, *best_row;
7822 int row_vpos, best_row_vpos;
7823 int current_x;
7824
7825 row = best_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7826 row_vpos = best_row_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7827
7828 while (row->y < yb)
7829 {
7830 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7831 line_start_position = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos;
7832 else
7833 line_start_position = 0;
7834
7835 if (line_start_position > pos)
7836 break;
7837 /* If the position sought is the end of the buffer,
7838 don't include the blank lines at the bottom of the window. */
7839 else if (line_start_position == pos
7840 && pos == BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
7841 {
7842 maybe_next_line_p = 1;
7843 break;
7844 }
7845 else if (line_start_position > 0)
7846 {
7847 best_row = row;
7848 best_row_vpos = row_vpos;
7849 }
7850
7851 if (row->y + row->height >= yb)
7852 break;
7853
7854 ++row;
7855 ++row_vpos;
7856 }
7857
7858 /* Find the right column within BEST_ROW. */
7859 lastcol = 0;
7860 current_x = best_row->x;
7861 for (i = 0; i < best_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
7862 {
7863 struct glyph *glyph = best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + i;
7864 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7865
7866 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
7867 {
7868 if (charpos == pos)
7869 {
7870 *hpos = i;
7871 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7872 *x = current_x;
7873 *y = best_row->y;
7874 return 1;
7875 }
7876 else if (charpos > pos)
7877 break;
7878 }
7879 else if (EQ (glyph->object, stop))
7880 break;
7881
7882 if (charpos > 0)
7883 lastcol = i;
7884 current_x += glyph->pixel_width;
7885 }
7886
7887 /* If we're looking for the end of the buffer,
7888 and we didn't find it in the line we scanned,
7889 use the start of the following line. */
7890 if (maybe_next_line_p)
7891 {
7892 ++best_row;
7893 ++best_row_vpos;
7894 lastcol = 0;
7895 current_x = best_row->x;
7896 }
7897
7898 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7899 *hpos = lastcol + 1;
7900 *x = current_x;
7901 *y = best_row->y;
7902 return 0;
7903 }
7904
7905 #endif /* not 0 */
7906
7907
7908 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
7909 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
7910 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
7911
7912 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
7913 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
7914
7915 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
7916 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
7917 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
7918 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
7919 next larger position in OBJECT.
7920
7921 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
7922
7923 static int
7924 fast_find_string_pos (w, pos, object, hpos, vpos, x, y, right_p)
7925 struct window *w;
7926 int pos;
7927 Lisp_Object object;
7928 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7929 int right_p;
7930 {
7931 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7932 struct glyph_row *r;
7933 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
7934 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
7935 int best_x = 0;
7936
7937 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7938 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
7939 ++r)
7940 {
7941 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7942 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
7943 int gx;
7944
7945 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
7946 if (EQ (g->object, object))
7947 {
7948 if (g->charpos == pos)
7949 {
7950 best_glyph = g;
7951 best_x = gx;
7952 best_row = r;
7953 goto found;
7954 }
7955 else if (best_glyph == NULL
7956 || ((abs (g->charpos - pos)
7957 < abs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
7958 && (right_p
7959 ? g->charpos < pos
7960 : g->charpos > pos)))
7961 {
7962 best_glyph = g;
7963 best_x = gx;
7964 best_row = r;
7965 }
7966 }
7967 }
7968
7969 found:
7970
7971 if (best_glyph)
7972 {
7973 *x = best_x;
7974 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7975
7976 if (right_p)
7977 {
7978 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
7979 ++*hpos;
7980 }
7981
7982 *y = best_row->y;
7983 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
7984 }
7985
7986 return best_glyph != NULL;
7987 }
7988
7989
7990 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_*
7991 in its mouse-face if HL > 0, in its normal face if HL = 0. */
7992
7993 static void
7994 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw)
7995 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7996 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7997 {
7998 struct window *w = XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window);
7999 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8000
8001 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
8002 to do anything. */
8003 w->current_matrix != NULL
8004 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
8005 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
8006 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
8007 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
8008 && dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
8009 {
8010 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
8011 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
8012
8013 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
8014 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
8015
8016 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
8017 {
8018 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
8019
8020 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
8021 if (row == first)
8022 {
8023 start_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
8024 start_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
8025 }
8026 else
8027 {
8028 start_hpos = 0;
8029 start_x = 0;
8030 }
8031
8032 if (row == last)
8033 end_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
8034 else
8035 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
8036
8037 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
8038 {
8039 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA,
8040 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
8041
8042 row->mouse_face_p
8043 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
8044 }
8045 }
8046
8047 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
8048 be displayed again. */
8049 if (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
8050 x_display_cursor (w, 1,
8051 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
8052 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
8053 }
8054
8055 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
8056 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
8057 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8058 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
8059 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
8060 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8061 f->output_data.x->cross_cursor);
8062 else
8063 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8064 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
8065 }
8066
8067 /* Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
8068 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
8069 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
8070
8071 static int
8072 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo)
8073 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8074 {
8075 int cleared = 0;
8076
8077 if (!NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
8078 {
8079 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
8080 cleared = 1;
8081 }
8082
8083 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
8084 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
8085 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
8086 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
8087 return cleared;
8088 }
8089
8090
8091 /* Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
8092 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
8093 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
8094
8095 static void
8096 x_clear_mouse_face (w)
8097 struct window *w;
8098 {
8099 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
8100 Lisp_Object window;
8101
8102 BLOCK_INPUT;
8103 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
8104 if (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
8105 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
8106 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8107 }
8108
8109
8110 /* Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
8111 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
8112
8113 void
8114 cancel_mouse_face (f)
8115 FRAME_PTR f;
8116 {
8117 Lisp_Object window;
8118 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8119
8120 window = dpyinfo->mouse_face_window;
8121 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
8122 {
8123 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
8124 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
8125 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
8126 }
8127 }
8128
8129 \f
8130 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
8131
8132
8133 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
8134 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
8135 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
8136 values. */
8137
8138 static int
8139 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
8140 struct frame *f;
8141 int x, y;
8142 XRectangle *rect;
8143 {
8144 Lisp_Object window;
8145 int part, found = 0;
8146
8147 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 0);
8148 if (!NILP (window))
8149 {
8150 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
8151 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
8152 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
8153
8154 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
8155
8156 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
8157 if (r->y >= y)
8158 {
8159 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
8160 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
8161 int gx;
8162
8163 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
8164 if (gx >= x)
8165 {
8166 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
8167 rect->height = r->height;
8168 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
8169 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
8170 found = 1;
8171 }
8172 }
8173 }
8174
8175 return found;
8176 }
8177
8178
8179 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
8180 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
8181
8182 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
8183 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
8184 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
8185 position on the scroll bar.
8186
8187 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
8188 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
8189 the mouse is over.
8190
8191 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
8192 was at this position.
8193
8194 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
8195
8196 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
8197 movement. */
8198
8199 static void
8200 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
8201 FRAME_PTR *fp;
8202 int insist;
8203 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
8204 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
8205 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
8206 unsigned long *time;
8207 {
8208 FRAME_PTR f1;
8209
8210 BLOCK_INPUT;
8211
8212 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
8213 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
8214 else
8215 {
8216 Window root;
8217 int root_x, root_y;
8218
8219 Window dummy_window;
8220 int dummy;
8221
8222 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8223
8224 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
8225 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8226 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
8227 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
8228
8229 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8230
8231 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
8232 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8233 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
8234
8235 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
8236 &root,
8237
8238 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
8239 a different screen. */
8240 &dummy_window,
8241
8242 /* The position on that root window. */
8243 &root_x, &root_y,
8244
8245 /* More trash we can't trust. */
8246 &dummy, &dummy,
8247
8248 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
8249 we don't care. */
8250 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
8251
8252 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
8253 containing the pointer. */
8254 {
8255 Window win, child;
8256 int win_x, win_y;
8257 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
8258 int count;
8259
8260 win = root;
8261
8262 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
8263 structure is changing at the same time this function
8264 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
8265
8266 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
8267
8268 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
8269 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
8270 {
8271 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
8272 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
8273 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8274
8275 /* From-window, to-window. */
8276 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
8277
8278 /* From-position, to-position. */
8279 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8280
8281 /* Child of win. */
8282 &child);
8283 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
8284 }
8285 else
8286 {
8287 while (1)
8288 {
8289 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8290
8291 /* From-window, to-window. */
8292 root, win,
8293
8294 /* From-position, to-position. */
8295 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8296
8297 /* Child of win. */
8298 &child);
8299
8300 if (child == None || child == win)
8301 break;
8302
8303 win = child;
8304 parent_x = win_x;
8305 parent_y = win_y;
8306 }
8307
8308 /* Now we know that:
8309 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
8310 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
8311 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
8312 (XTC did this the last time through), and
8313 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
8314 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
8315 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
8316 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
8317 never use them in that case.) */
8318
8319 /* Is win one of our frames? */
8320 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
8321
8322 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8323 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
8324 on the frame. */
8325 if (f1 != NULL
8326 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
8327 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
8328 f1 = NULL;
8329 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8330 }
8331
8332 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
8333 f1 = 0;
8334
8335 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
8336
8337 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
8338 if (! f1)
8339 {
8340 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
8341
8342 if (bar)
8343 {
8344 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8345 win_x = parent_x;
8346 win_y = parent_y;
8347 }
8348 }
8349
8350 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
8351 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
8352
8353 if (f1)
8354 {
8355 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
8356 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
8357 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
8358 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
8359 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
8360 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
8361 the frame are divided into. */
8362
8363 int width, height, gx, gy;
8364 XRectangle rect;
8365
8366 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
8367 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
8368 else
8369 {
8370 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
8371 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
8372 gx = win_x;
8373 gy = win_y;
8374
8375 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to
8376 round down even for negative values. */
8377 if (gx < 0)
8378 gx -= width - 1;
8379 if (gy < 0)
8380 gy -= height - 1;
8381 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
8382 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
8383
8384 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
8385 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
8386 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
8387 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
8388 }
8389
8390 *bar_window = Qnil;
8391 *part = 0;
8392 *fp = f1;
8393 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
8394 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
8395 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
8396 }
8397 }
8398 }
8399
8400 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8401 }
8402
8403
8404 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8405
8406 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
8407 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
8408 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
8409 that slows us down. */
8410
8411 static void
8412 x_process_timeouts (timer)
8413 struct atimer *timer;
8414 {
8415 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
8416 {
8417 BLOCK_INPUT;
8418 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
8419 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
8420 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8421 }
8422 }
8423
8424 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8425
8426 \f
8427 /* Scroll bar support. */
8428
8429 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
8430 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
8431 bits. */
8432
8433 static struct scroll_bar *
8434 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
8435 Window window_id;
8436 {
8437 Lisp_Object tail;
8438
8439 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8440 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8441 tail = XCDR (tail))
8442 {
8443 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
8444
8445 frame = XCAR (tail);
8446 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
8447 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
8448 abort ();
8449
8450 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
8451 right window ID. */
8452 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8453 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8454 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
8455 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
8456 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
8457 condemned = Qnil,
8458 ! GC_NILP (bar));
8459 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
8460 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
8461 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8462 }
8463
8464 return 0;
8465 }
8466
8467
8468 #if defined USE_LUCID
8469
8470 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
8471 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
8472
8473 static Widget
8474 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
8475 Window window;
8476 {
8477 Lisp_Object tail;
8478
8479 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8480 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8481 tail = XCDR (tail))
8482 {
8483 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
8484 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
8485
8486 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
8487 return menu_bar;
8488 }
8489
8490 return NULL;
8491 }
8492
8493 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
8494
8495 \f
8496 /************************************************************************
8497 Toolkit scroll bars
8498 ************************************************************************/
8499
8500 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8501
8502 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
8503 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
8504 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
8505 struct scroll_bar *));
8506 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
8507 int, int, int));
8508
8509
8510 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
8511 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
8512
8513 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
8514
8515 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
8516
8517 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
8518
8519 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
8520 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
8521
8522 #ifndef USE_GTK
8523 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
8524
8525 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
8526
8527 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
8528
8529 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
8530 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
8531 to avoid jerkyness. */
8532
8533 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
8534
8535
8536 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
8537 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
8538 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
8539 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
8540
8541 static void
8542 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
8543 num_params)
8544 Widget widget;
8545 XtPointer client_data;
8546 String action_name;
8547 XEvent *event;
8548 String *params;
8549 Cardinal *num_params;
8550 {
8551 int scroll_bar_p;
8552 char *end_action;
8553
8554 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8555 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
8556 end_action = "Release";
8557 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8558 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
8559 end_action = "EndScroll";
8560 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
8561
8562 if (scroll_bar_p
8563 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
8564 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
8565 {
8566 struct window *w;
8567
8568 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
8569 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
8570 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
8571 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
8572 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
8573 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
8574
8575 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
8576 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
8577 }
8578 }
8579 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8580
8581 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
8582 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
8583
8584 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
8585 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
8586
8587
8588 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
8589 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
8590 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
8591 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
8592
8593 static void
8594 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
8595 Lisp_Object window;
8596 int part, portion, whole;
8597 {
8598 XEvent event;
8599 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
8600 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
8601 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8602 int i;
8603
8604 BLOCK_INPUT;
8605
8606 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
8607 ev->type = ClientMessage;
8608 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
8609 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8610 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8611 ev->format = 32;
8612
8613 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
8614 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
8615 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
8616 into that array in the event. */
8617 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
8618 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
8619 break;
8620
8621 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
8622 {
8623 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
8624 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8625 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8626
8627 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
8628 nbytes);
8629 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
8630 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
8631 }
8632
8633 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
8634 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
8635 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
8636 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
8637 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
8638 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
8639
8640 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
8641 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
8642
8643 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
8644 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
8645 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
8646 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
8647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8648 }
8649
8650
8651 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
8652 in *IEVENT. */
8653
8654 static void
8655 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
8656 XEvent *event;
8657 struct input_event *ievent;
8658 {
8659 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
8660 Lisp_Object window;
8661 struct frame *f;
8662 struct window *w;
8663
8664 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
8665 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
8666
8667 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
8668 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8669
8670 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
8671 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
8672 ievent->arg = Qnil;
8673 #ifdef USE_GTK
8674 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
8675 #else
8676 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8677 #endif
8678 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
8679 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
8680 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
8681 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
8682 ievent->modifiers = 0;
8683 }
8684
8685
8686 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8687
8688 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
8689
8690 #define XM_SB_MIN 1
8691 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
8692 #define XM_SB_RANGE (XM_SB_MAX - XM_SB_MIN)
8693
8694
8695 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
8696 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
8697 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
8698
8699 static void
8700 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8701 Widget widget;
8702 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8703 {
8704 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8705 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
8706 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
8707
8708 switch (cs->reason)
8709 {
8710 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
8711 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8712 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
8713 break;
8714
8715 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
8716 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8717 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8718 break;
8719
8720 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
8721 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8722 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8723 break;
8724
8725 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
8726 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8727 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8728 break;
8729
8730 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
8731 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8732 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
8733 break;
8734
8735 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
8736 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8737 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
8738 break;
8739
8740 case XmCR_DRAG:
8741 {
8742 int slider_size;
8743 int dragging_down_p = (INTEGERP (bar->dragging)
8744 && XINT (bar->dragging) <= cs->value);
8745
8746 /* Get the slider size. */
8747 BLOCK_INPUT;
8748 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
8749 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8750
8751 whole = XM_SB_RANGE - slider_size;
8752 portion = min (cs->value - XM_SB_MIN, whole);
8753 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8754 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
8755 }
8756 break;
8757
8758 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
8759 break;
8760 };
8761
8762 if (part >= 0)
8763 {
8764 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8765 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8766 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8767 }
8768 }
8769
8770
8771 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
8772 #ifdef USE_GTK
8773 /* Scroll bar callback for Gtk scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
8774 bar adjustment widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
8775
8776 static void
8777 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
8778 GtkWidget *widget;
8779 gpointer data;
8780 {
8781 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
8782 gdouble previous;
8783 gdouble position;
8784 gdouble *p;
8785 int diff;
8786
8787 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
8788 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (widget);
8789
8790 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
8791
8792 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
8793
8794 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
8795 if (! p)
8796 {
8797 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
8798 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
8799 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
8800 }
8801
8802 previous = *p;
8803 *p = position;
8804
8805 diff = (int) (position - previous);
8806
8807 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
8808 {
8809 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8810 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8811 }
8812 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
8813 {
8814 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
8815 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8816 }
8817 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
8818 {
8819 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8820 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8821 }
8822 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
8823 {
8824 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8825 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8826 }
8827 else
8828 {
8829 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8830 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
8831 portion = min (position, whole);
8832 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
8833 }
8834
8835 if (part >= 0)
8836 {
8837 xg_ignore_next_thumb = 1;
8838 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8839 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8840 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8841 }
8842 }
8843
8844 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8845
8846 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
8847 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
8848 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
8849 the thumb is. */
8850
8851 static void
8852 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8853 Widget widget;
8854 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8855 {
8856 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8857 float top = *(float *) call_data;
8858 float shown;
8859 int whole, portion, height;
8860 int part;
8861
8862 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
8863 BLOCK_INPUT;
8864 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8865 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8866
8867 whole = 10000000;
8868 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
8869
8870 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
8871 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
8872 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
8873 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
8874 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
8875 bottom). */
8876 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8877 else
8878 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8879
8880 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8881 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
8882 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8883 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8884 }
8885
8886
8887 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
8888 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
8889 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
8890 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
8891 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
8892 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
8893 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
8894
8895 static void
8896 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8897 Widget widget;
8898 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8899 {
8900 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8901 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
8902 int position = (long) call_data;
8903 Dimension height;
8904 int part;
8905
8906 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
8907 BLOCK_INPUT;
8908 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8910
8911 if (abs (position) >= height)
8912 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
8913
8914 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
8915 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
8916 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
8917 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8918 else
8919 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
8920
8921 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8922 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8923 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8924 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
8925 }
8926
8927 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8928 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
8929
8930 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
8931
8932 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
8933 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
8934
8935 #ifdef USE_GTK
8936 static void
8937 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
8938 struct frame *f;
8939 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8940 {
8941 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
8942
8943 BLOCK_INPUT;
8944 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
8945 scroll_bar_name);
8946 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8947 }
8948
8949 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8950
8951 static void
8952 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
8953 struct frame *f;
8954 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8955 {
8956 Window xwindow;
8957 Widget widget;
8958 Arg av[20];
8959 int ac = 0;
8960 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
8961 unsigned long pixel;
8962
8963 BLOCK_INPUT;
8964
8965 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8966 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
8967 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8968 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, XM_SB_MIN); ++ac;
8969 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
8970 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
8971 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
8972 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
8973 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
8974
8975 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8976 if (pixel != -1)
8977 {
8978 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
8979 ++ac;
8980 }
8981
8982 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8983 if (pixel != -1)
8984 {
8985 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
8986 ++ac;
8987 }
8988
8989 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
8990 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
8991
8992 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
8993 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8994 (XtPointer) bar);
8995 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8996 (XtPointer) bar);
8997 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8998 (XtPointer) bar);
8999 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
9000 (XtPointer) bar);
9001 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
9002 (XtPointer) bar);
9003 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
9004 (XtPointer) bar);
9005 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
9006 (XtPointer) bar);
9007
9008 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
9009 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
9010
9011 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
9012 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
9013 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
9014 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
9015
9016 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
9017
9018 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
9019 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
9020 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
9021 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
9022 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
9023 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
9024 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
9025 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
9026
9027 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
9028 if (pixel != -1)
9029 {
9030 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
9031 ++ac;
9032 }
9033
9034 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
9035 if (pixel != -1)
9036 {
9037 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
9038 ++ac;
9039 }
9040
9041 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
9042
9043 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
9044 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
9045 {
9046 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
9047 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
9048 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
9049 pixel = -1;
9050 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
9051 }
9052 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
9053 {
9054 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
9055 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
9056 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
9057 pixel = -1;
9058 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
9059 }
9060
9061 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
9062 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
9063 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
9064 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
9065 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
9066 {
9067 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
9068 ++ac;
9069 }
9070 else
9071 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
9072 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
9073 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
9074 {
9075 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
9076 the shadows. */
9077 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
9078 ++ac;
9079
9080 /* Specify the colors. */
9081 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
9082 if (pixel != -1)
9083 {
9084 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
9085 ++ac;
9086 }
9087 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
9088 if (pixel != -1)
9089 {
9090 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
9091 ++ac;
9092 }
9093 }
9094
9095 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
9096 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
9097
9098 {
9099 char *initial = "";
9100 char *val = initial;
9101 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
9102 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
9103 if (val == initial)
9104 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
9105 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
9106 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
9107 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
9108 }
9109 }
9110
9111 /* Define callbacks. */
9112 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
9113 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
9114 (XtPointer) bar);
9115
9116 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
9117 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
9118
9119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
9120
9121 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
9122 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
9123 if (action_hook_id == 0)
9124 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
9125
9126 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
9127 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
9128 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
9129 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
9130
9131 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9132 }
9133 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9134
9135
9136 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
9137 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
9138
9139 #ifdef USE_GTK
9140 static void
9141 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
9142 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9143 int portion, position, whole;
9144 {
9145 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
9146 }
9147
9148 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9149 static void
9150 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
9151 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9152 int portion, position, whole;
9153 {
9154 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9155 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
9156 float top, shown;
9157
9158 BLOCK_INPUT;
9159
9160 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
9161
9162 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
9163 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
9164 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
9165 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
9166 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
9167 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
9168 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
9169 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
9170 its size, the update will often happen too late.
9171 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
9172 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
9173 portion = XFASTINT (XWINDOW (bar->window)->height) * 30;
9174 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
9175 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
9176 whole += portion;
9177
9178 if (whole <= 0)
9179 top = 0, shown = 1;
9180 else
9181 {
9182 top = (float) position / whole;
9183 shown = (float) portion / whole;
9184 }
9185
9186 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
9187 {
9188 int size, value;
9189
9190 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
9191 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
9192 value. */
9193 size = shown * XM_SB_RANGE;
9194 size = min (size, XM_SB_RANGE);
9195 size = max (size, 1);
9196
9197 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
9198 value = top * XM_SB_RANGE;
9199 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
9200 value = max (value, XM_SB_MIN);
9201
9202 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
9203 }
9204 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
9205
9206 if (whole == 0)
9207 top = 0, shown = 1;
9208 else
9209 {
9210 top = (float) position / whole;
9211 shown = (float) portion / whole;
9212 }
9213
9214 {
9215 float old_top, old_shown;
9216 Dimension height;
9217 XtVaGetValues (widget,
9218 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
9219 XtNshown, &old_shown,
9220 XtNheight, &height,
9221 NULL);
9222
9223 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
9224 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
9225 top = max (0, min (1, top));
9226 else
9227 top = old_top;
9228 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
9229 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
9230
9231 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
9232 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
9233 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
9234 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
9235 {
9236 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
9237 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
9238 else
9239 {
9240 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
9241 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
9242 int scroll_mode = 0;
9243
9244 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
9245 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
9246 {
9247 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
9248 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
9249 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
9250 if (scroll_mode == 2)
9251 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
9252 }
9253 #endif
9254 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
9255 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
9256 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
9257
9258 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
9259
9260 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
9261 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
9262 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
9263 #endif
9264 }
9265 }
9266 }
9267 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
9268
9269 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9270 }
9271 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9272
9273 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9274
9275
9276 \f
9277 /************************************************************************
9278 Scroll bars, general
9279 ************************************************************************/
9280
9281 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
9282 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
9283 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
9284 scroll bar. */
9285
9286 static struct scroll_bar *
9287 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
9288 struct window *w;
9289 int top, left, width, height;
9290 {
9291 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
9292 struct scroll_bar *bar
9293 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
9294
9295 BLOCK_INPUT;
9296
9297 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9298 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
9299 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9300 {
9301 XSetWindowAttributes a;
9302 unsigned long mask;
9303 Window window;
9304
9305 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
9306 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
9307 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
9308
9309 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
9310 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
9311 | ExposureMask);
9312 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
9313
9314 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
9315
9316 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
9317 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
9318 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
9319 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9320 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9321 left, top, width,
9322 window_box_height (w), False);
9323
9324 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9325 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
9326 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9327 top,
9328 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9329 height,
9330 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
9331 0,
9332 CopyFromParent,
9333 CopyFromParent,
9334 CopyFromParent,
9335 /* Attributes. */
9336 mask, &a);
9337 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
9338 }
9339 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9340
9341 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
9342 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9343 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
9344 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
9345 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9346 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
9347 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
9348 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9349
9350 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
9351 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9352 bar->prev = Qnil;
9353 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9354 if (!NILP (bar->next))
9355 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9356
9357 /* Map the window/widget. */
9358 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9359 {
9360 #ifdef USE_GTK
9361 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
9362 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
9363 top,
9364 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9365 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9366 max (height, 1));
9367 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9368 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9369 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
9370 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
9371 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9372 top,
9373 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9374 max (height, 1), 0);
9375 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
9376 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9377 }
9378 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9379 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9380 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9381
9382 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9383 return bar;
9384 }
9385
9386
9387 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
9388
9389 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
9390 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
9391 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
9392 events.)
9393
9394 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
9395 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
9396 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
9397 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
9398 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
9399
9400 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9401
9402 static void
9403 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
9404 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9405 int start, end;
9406 int rebuild;
9407 {
9408 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
9409 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9410 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9411 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9412
9413 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
9414 if (! rebuild
9415 && start == XINT (bar->start)
9416 && end == XINT (bar->end))
9417 return;
9418
9419 BLOCK_INPUT;
9420
9421 {
9422 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
9423 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9424 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9425
9426 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
9427 the distance between start and end. */
9428 {
9429 int length = end - start;
9430
9431 if (start < 0)
9432 start = 0;
9433 else if (start > top_range)
9434 start = top_range;
9435 end = start + length;
9436
9437 if (end < start)
9438 end = start;
9439 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
9440 end = top_range;
9441 }
9442
9443 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
9444 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
9445 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
9446
9447 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
9448 if (end > top_range)
9449 end = top_range;
9450
9451 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
9452 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
9453 that many pixels tall. */
9454 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
9455
9456 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
9457 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9458 if (0 < start)
9459 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9460 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9461 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9462 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
9463 inside_width, start,
9464 False);
9465
9466 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
9467 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9468 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9469 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9470
9471 /* Draw the handle itself. */
9472 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9473 /* x, y, width, height */
9474 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9475 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
9476 inside_width, end - start);
9477
9478 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
9479 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9480 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9481 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9482
9483 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
9484 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9485 if (end < inside_height)
9486 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9487 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9488 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9489 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
9490 inside_width, inside_height - end,
9491 False);
9492
9493 }
9494
9495 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9496 }
9497
9498 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9499
9500 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
9501 nil. */
9502
9503 static void
9504 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
9505 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9506 {
9507 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9508 BLOCK_INPUT;
9509
9510 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9511 #ifdef USE_GTK
9512 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9513 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9514 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
9515 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9516 #else
9517 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9518 #endif
9519
9520 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
9521 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
9522
9523 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9524 }
9525
9526
9527 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
9528 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
9529 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
9530 create one. */
9531
9532 static void
9533 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
9534 struct window *w;
9535 int portion, whole, position;
9536 {
9537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
9538 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9539 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
9540 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
9541
9542 /* Get window dimensions. */
9543 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
9544 top = window_y;
9545 width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9546 height = window_height;
9547
9548 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
9549 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9550 left = XINT (w->left) + XINT (w->width) - FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f);
9551 else
9552 left = XFASTINT (w->left);
9553 left *= CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9554 left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
9555
9556 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
9557 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
9558 if (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0)
9559 sb_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9560 else
9561 sb_width = width;
9562
9563 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
9564 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9565 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9566 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
9567 else
9568 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
9569 #else
9570 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9571 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
9572 else
9573 sb_left = left;
9574 #endif
9575
9576 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
9577 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
9578 {
9579 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9580 {
9581 BLOCK_INPUT;
9582 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9583 left, top, width, height, False);
9584 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9585 }
9586
9587 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
9588 }
9589 else
9590 {
9591 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
9592 unsigned int mask = 0;
9593
9594 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
9595
9596 BLOCK_INPUT;
9597
9598 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
9599 mask |= CWX;
9600 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
9601 mask |= CWY;
9602 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
9603 mask |= CWWidth;
9604 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
9605 mask |= CWHeight;
9606
9607 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9608
9609 #ifdef USE_GTK
9610 if (mask)
9611 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
9612 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
9613 top,
9614 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9615 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9616 max (height, 1));
9617 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9618
9619 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
9620 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
9621 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9622 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9623 left, top, width, height, False);
9624 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
9625 if (mask)
9626 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
9627 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9628 top,
9629 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9630 max (height, 1), 0);
9631
9632 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9633 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9634
9635 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
9636 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
9637 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
9638 {
9639 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9640 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9641 height, False);
9642 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9643 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9644 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9645 height, False);
9646 }
9647
9648 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
9649 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
9650 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
9651 example. */
9652 {
9653 int area_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9654 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
9655 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
9656 {
9657 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (f))
9658 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9659 left + area_width - rest, top,
9660 rest, height, False);
9661 else
9662 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9663 left, top, rest, height, False);
9664 }
9665 }
9666
9667 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
9668 if (mask)
9669 {
9670 XWindowChanges wc;
9671
9672 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9673 wc.y = top;
9674 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
9675 wc.height = height;
9676 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
9677 mask, &wc);
9678 }
9679
9680 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9681
9682 /* Remember new settings. */
9683 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
9684 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9685 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
9686 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9687
9688 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9689 }
9690
9691 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9692 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
9693 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9694 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
9695 dragged. */
9696 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
9697 {
9698 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
9699
9700 if (whole == 0)
9701 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
9702 else
9703 {
9704 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
9705 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
9706 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
9707 }
9708 }
9709 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9710
9711 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
9712 }
9713
9714
9715 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
9716 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
9717 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
9718 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
9719 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
9720 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
9721 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
9722
9723 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
9724 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
9725 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
9726
9727 static void
9728 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
9729 FRAME_PTR frame;
9730 {
9731 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
9732 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9733 {
9734 Lisp_Object bar;
9735 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9736 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
9737 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9738 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
9739 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9740 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
9741 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
9742 }
9743 }
9744
9745
9746 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
9747 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
9748
9749 static void
9750 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
9751 struct window *window;
9752 {
9753 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9754 struct frame *f;
9755
9756 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
9757 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9758 abort ();
9759
9760 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
9761
9762 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
9763 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
9764 if (NILP (bar->prev))
9765 {
9766 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
9767 the lists. */
9768 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9769 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
9770 return;
9771 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
9772 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9773 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
9774 else
9775 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
9776 one or the other! */
9777 abort ();
9778 }
9779 else
9780 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
9781
9782 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9783 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
9784
9785 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9786 bar->prev = Qnil;
9787 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9788 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9789 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9790 }
9791
9792 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
9793 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
9794
9795 static void
9796 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
9797 FRAME_PTR f;
9798 {
9799 Lisp_Object bar, next;
9800
9801 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9802
9803 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
9804 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
9805 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
9806
9807 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
9808 {
9809 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9810
9811 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9812
9813 next = b->next;
9814 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
9815 }
9816
9817 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
9818 and they should get garbage-collected. */
9819 }
9820
9821
9822 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
9823 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
9824
9825 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9826 mark bits. */
9827
9828 static void
9829 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
9830 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9831 XEvent *event;
9832 {
9833 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9834
9835 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9836 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9837 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9838 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9839
9840 BLOCK_INPUT;
9841
9842 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
9843
9844 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
9845 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9846
9847 /* x, y, width, height */
9848 0, 0,
9849 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
9850 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
9851
9852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9853
9854 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9855 }
9856
9857 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
9858 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
9859
9860 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9861 mark bits. */
9862
9863 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9864
9865 static void
9866 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
9867 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9868 XEvent *event;
9869 struct input_event *emacs_event;
9870 {
9871 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
9872 abort ();
9873
9874 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
9875 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
9876 emacs_event->modifiers
9877 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
9878 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
9879 event->xbutton.state)
9880 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
9881 ? up_modifier
9882 : down_modifier));
9883 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
9884 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
9885 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
9886 {
9887 #if 0
9888 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9889 int internal_height
9890 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9891 #endif
9892 int top_range
9893 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9894 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
9895
9896 if (y < 0) y = 0;
9897 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
9898
9899 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
9900 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
9901 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
9902 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
9903 else
9904 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
9905
9906 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
9907 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
9908 whether or not we're dragging. */
9909 #if 0
9910 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
9911 holding it. */
9912 if (event->type == ButtonPress
9913 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9914 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
9915 #endif
9916
9917 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
9918 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
9919 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
9920 {
9921 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9922 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9923
9924 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9925 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9926 }
9927
9928 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
9929 #if 0
9930 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
9931 the handle. */
9932 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9933 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
9934 else
9935 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9936 #else
9937 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9938 #endif
9939
9940 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
9941 }
9942 }
9943
9944 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
9945
9946 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9947 mark bits. */
9948
9949 static void
9950 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
9951 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9952 XEvent *event;
9953 {
9954 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
9955
9956 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
9957
9958 f->mouse_moved = 1;
9959 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
9960
9961 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
9962 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
9963 {
9964 /* Where should the handle be now? */
9965 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9966
9967 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
9968 {
9969 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9970
9971 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9972 }
9973 }
9974 }
9975
9976 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9977
9978 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
9979 on the scroll bar. */
9980
9981 static void
9982 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
9983 FRAME_PTR *fp;
9984 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
9985 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
9986 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
9987 unsigned long *time;
9988 {
9989 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
9990 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9991 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9992 int win_x, win_y;
9993 Window dummy_window;
9994 int dummy_coord;
9995 unsigned int dummy_mask;
9996
9997 BLOCK_INPUT;
9998
9999 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
10000 report that. */
10001 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
10002
10003 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
10004 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
10005 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
10006
10007 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
10008 &win_x, &win_y,
10009
10010 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
10011 &dummy_mask))
10012 ;
10013 else
10014 {
10015 #if 0
10016 int inside_height
10017 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
10018 #endif
10019 int top_range
10020 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
10021
10022 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
10023
10024 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
10025 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
10026
10027 if (win_y < 0)
10028 win_y = 0;
10029 if (win_y > top_range)
10030 win_y = top_range;
10031
10032 *fp = f;
10033 *bar_window = bar->window;
10034
10035 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
10036 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
10037 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
10038 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
10039 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
10040 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
10041 else
10042 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
10043
10044 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
10045 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
10046
10047 f->mouse_moved = 0;
10048 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10049 }
10050
10051 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
10052
10053 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10054 }
10055
10056
10057 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
10058 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
10059 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
10060 redraw them. */
10061
10062 void
10063 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
10064 FRAME_PTR f;
10065 {
10066 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10067 Lisp_Object bar;
10068
10069 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
10070 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
10071 But in that case we should not clear them. */
10072 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
10073 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
10074 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
10075 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10076 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
10077 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
10078 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10079 }
10080
10081 \f
10082 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
10083
10084 struct selection_event_queue
10085 {
10086 XEvent event;
10087 struct selection_event_queue *next;
10088 };
10089
10090 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
10091
10092 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
10093
10094 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
10095
10096 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
10097
10098 static void
10099 x_queue_event (f, event)
10100 FRAME_PTR f;
10101 XEvent *event;
10102 {
10103 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
10104 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
10105
10106 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
10107 {
10108 queue_tmp->event = *event;
10109 queue_tmp->next = queue;
10110 queue = queue_tmp;
10111 }
10112 }
10113
10114 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
10115 so that they get processed afresh. */
10116
10117 static void
10118 x_unqueue_events (display)
10119 Display *display;
10120 {
10121 while (queue != NULL)
10122 {
10123 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
10124 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
10125 queue = queue_tmp->next;
10126 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
10127 }
10128 }
10129
10130 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
10131
10132 void
10133 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
10134 Display *display;
10135 {
10136 x_queue_selection_requests++;
10137 }
10138
10139 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
10140
10141 void
10142 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
10143 Display *display;
10144 {
10145 x_queue_selection_requests--;
10146 x_unqueue_events (display);
10147 }
10148 \f
10149 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
10150
10151 #if 0
10152 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
10153 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
10154 sometimes don't work. */
10155
10156 static Time enter_timestamp;
10157 #endif
10158
10159 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
10160 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
10161 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
10162 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
10163
10164 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
10165 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
10166
10167 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
10168
10169 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
10170 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
10171
10172 static int temp_index;
10173 static short temp_buffer[100];
10174
10175 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
10176 on a particular display. */
10177
10178 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
10179
10180 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
10181 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
10182 We try all the open displays, one by one.
10183 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
10184
10185 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
10186
10187 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
10188 do \
10189 { \
10190 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
10191 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
10192 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
10193 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
10194 if (numchars >= 1) \
10195 { \
10196 bufp->kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
10197 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
10198 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
10199 bufp++; \
10200 count++; \
10201 numchars--; \
10202 } \
10203 } \
10204 while (0)
10205
10206 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
10207 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
10208
10209
10210 enum
10211 {
10212 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
10213 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
10214 X_EVENT_DROP
10215 };
10216
10217 #ifdef USE_GTK
10218 static struct x_display_info *current_dpyinfo;
10219 static struct input_event **current_bufp;
10220 static int *current_numcharsp;
10221 static int current_count;
10222 static int current_finish;
10223
10224 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
10225 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
10226 so we have a chanse to act on the event before GTK. */
10227 static GdkFilterReturn
10228 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
10229 GdkXEvent *gxev;
10230 GdkEvent *ev;
10231 gpointer data;
10232 {
10233 XEvent *xev = (XEvent*)gxev;
10234
10235 if (current_numcharsp)
10236 current_count += handle_one_xevent (current_dpyinfo,
10237 xev,
10238 current_bufp,
10239 current_numcharsp,
10240 &current_finish);
10241 else
10242 x_dispatch_event (xev, GDK_DISPLAY ());
10243
10244 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
10245 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
10246
10247 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
10248 }
10249 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10250
10251
10252 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
10253
10254 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
10255 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
10256 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
10257
10258 Events representing keys are stored in buffer *BUFP_R,
10259 which can hold up to *NUMCHARSP characters.
10260 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
10261
10262 static int
10263 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, bufp_r, numcharsp, finish)
10264 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10265 XEvent *eventp;
10266 /* register */ struct input_event **bufp_r;
10267 /* register */ int *numcharsp;
10268 int *finish;
10269 {
10270 int count = 0;
10271 int nbytes = 0;
10272 struct frame *f;
10273 struct coding_system coding;
10274 struct input_event *bufp = *bufp_r;
10275 int numchars = *numcharsp;
10276 XEvent event = *eventp;
10277
10278 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
10279
10280 switch (event.type)
10281 {
10282 case ClientMessage:
10283 {
10284 if (event.xclient.message_type
10285 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10286 && event.xclient.format == 32)
10287 {
10288 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10289 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
10290 {
10291 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
10292 could be the shell widget window
10293 if the frame has no title bar. */
10294 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10295 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10296 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
10297 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10298 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10299 #endif
10300 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
10301 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
10302 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
10303 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
10304 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
10305 needed.
10306
10307 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
10308 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
10309 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
10310 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
10311 Emacs. */
10312
10313 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
10314 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
10315 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
10316 if (f)
10317 {
10318 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
10319 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
10320 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
10321 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
10322 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
10323 /* The ICCCM says this is
10324 the only valid choice. */
10325 RevertToParent,
10326 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
10327 /* This is needed to detect the error
10328 if there is an error. */
10329 XSync (d, False);
10330 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
10331 }
10332 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
10333 #endif /* 0 */
10334 }
10335 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10336 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
10337 {
10338 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
10339 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
10340 the session manager, who's looking for such a
10341 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
10342 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
10343 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
10344 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
10345 session manager and one for this. */
10346 if (numchars > 0
10347 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10348 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
10349 #endif
10350 )
10351 {
10352 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10353 event.xclient.window);
10354 /* This is just so we only give real data once
10355 for a single Emacs process. */
10356 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
10357 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10358 event.xclient.window,
10359 initial_argv, initial_argc);
10360 else if (f)
10361 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10362 event.xclient.window,
10363 0, 0);
10364 }
10365 }
10366 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10367 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
10368 {
10369 struct frame *f
10370 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10371 event.xclient.window);
10372
10373 if (f)
10374 {
10375 if (numchars == 0)
10376 abort ();
10377
10378 bufp->kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
10379 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10380 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10381 bufp++;
10382
10383 count += 1;
10384 numchars -= 1;
10385 }
10386 else
10387 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
10388 }
10389 }
10390 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10391 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
10392 {
10393 }
10394 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10395 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
10396 {
10397 int new_x, new_y;
10398 struct frame *f
10399 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10400
10401 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
10402 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
10403
10404 if (f)
10405 {
10406 f->output_data.x->left_pos = new_x;
10407 f->output_data.x->top_pos = new_y;
10408 }
10409 }
10410 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
10411 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10412 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
10413 {
10414 struct frame *f
10415 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10416 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
10417 &event, NULL);
10418 }
10419 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
10420 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
10421 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
10422 || (event.xclient.message_type
10423 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
10424 {
10425 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
10426 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
10427 currently never do because we are interested in
10428 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
10429 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
10430 struct frame *f
10431 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10432 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
10433 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
10434 }
10435 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10436 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
10437 we construct an input_event. */
10438 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10439 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
10440 {
10441 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
10442 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10443 goto out;
10444 }
10445 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10446 else
10447 goto OTHER;
10448 }
10449 break;
10450
10451 case SelectionNotify:
10452 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10453 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
10454 goto OTHER;
10455 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10456 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
10457 break;
10458
10459 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
10460 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10461 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
10462 goto OTHER;
10463 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10464 {
10465 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
10466
10467 if (numchars == 0)
10468 abort ();
10469
10470 bufp->kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
10471 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10472 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10473 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10474 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10475 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10476 bufp++;
10477
10478 count += 1;
10479 numchars -= 1;
10480 }
10481 break;
10482
10483 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
10484 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10485 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
10486 goto OTHER;
10487 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10488 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
10489 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
10490 &event);
10491 else
10492 {
10493 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
10494 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
10495
10496 if (numchars == 0)
10497 abort ();
10498
10499 bufp->kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
10500 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10501 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
10502 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10503 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
10504 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
10505 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10506 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10507 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10508 bufp++;
10509
10510 count += 1;
10511 numchars -= 1;
10512 }
10513 break;
10514
10515 case PropertyNotify:
10516 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
10517 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
10518 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
10519 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
10520 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
10521 goto OTHER;
10522 #endif
10523 #endif
10524 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
10525 goto OTHER;
10526
10527 case ReparentNotify:
10528 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
10529 if (f)
10530 {
10531 int x, y;
10532 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
10533 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
10534 f->output_data.x->left_pos = x;
10535 f->output_data.x->top_pos = y;
10536 goto OTHER;
10537 }
10538 break;
10539
10540 case Expose:
10541 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
10542 if (f)
10543 {
10544 x_check_fullscreen (f);
10545
10546 if (f->async_visible == 0)
10547 {
10548 f->async_visible = 1;
10549 f->async_iconified = 0;
10550 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10551 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10552 }
10553 else
10554 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10555 event.xexpose.window),
10556 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
10557 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
10558 }
10559 else
10560 {
10561 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10562 struct scroll_bar *bar;
10563 #endif
10564 #if defined USE_LUCID
10565 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
10566 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
10567 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
10568 {
10569 Widget widget
10570 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10571 if (widget)
10572 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
10573 }
10574 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
10575
10576 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10577 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
10578 goto OTHER;
10579 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10580 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10581
10582 if (bar)
10583 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
10584 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10585 else
10586 goto OTHER;
10587 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10588 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10589 }
10590 break;
10591
10592 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10593 source area was obscured or not
10594 available. */
10595 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
10596 if (f)
10597 {
10598 expose_frame (f,
10599 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
10600 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
10601 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
10602 }
10603 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10604 else
10605 goto OTHER;
10606 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10607 break;
10608
10609 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10610 source area was completely
10611 available. */
10612 break;
10613
10614 case UnmapNotify:
10615 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
10616 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10617 {
10618 tip_window = 0;
10619 redo_mouse_highlight ();
10620 }
10621
10622 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
10623 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
10624 the frame was deleted. */
10625 {
10626 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
10627 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
10628 display that won't ever be seen. */
10629 f->async_visible = 0;
10630 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
10631 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
10632 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
10633 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
10634 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
10635 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
10636 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
10637 {
10638 f->async_iconified = 1;
10639
10640 bufp->kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
10641 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10642 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10643 bufp++;
10644 count++;
10645 numchars--;
10646 }
10647 }
10648 goto OTHER;
10649
10650 case MapNotify:
10651 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10652 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
10653 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
10654 goto OTHER;
10655
10656 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
10657 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
10658 frame is visible. */
10659 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
10660 if (f)
10661 {
10662 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
10663 the frame's display structures.
10664 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
10665 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
10666 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
10667 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
10668 if (! f->async_iconified)
10669 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10670
10671 f->async_visible = 1;
10672 f->async_iconified = 0;
10673 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10674
10675 if (f->iconified)
10676 {
10677 bufp->kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
10678 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10679 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10680 bufp++;
10681 count++;
10682 numchars--;
10683 }
10684 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
10685 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
10686 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
10687 to update the frame titles
10688 in case this is the second frame. */
10689 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
10690 }
10691 goto OTHER;
10692
10693 case KeyPress:
10694
10695 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
10696 if (popup_activated ())
10697 goto OTHER;
10698
10699 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
10700
10701 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
10702 {
10703 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
10704 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10705 }
10706
10707 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10708 if (f == 0)
10709 {
10710 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
10711 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
10712 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
10713 event.xkey.window);
10714 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
10715 {
10716 widget = XtParent (widget);
10717 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
10718 }
10719 }
10720 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10721
10722 if (f != 0)
10723 {
10724 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
10725 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
10726 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
10727 his Emacs hang.
10728
10729 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
10730 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
10731 status_return even if the input is too long to
10732 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
10733 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
10734 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
10735 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
10736 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
10737 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
10738 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
10739 int modifiers;
10740 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
10741
10742 event.xkey.state
10743 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10744 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
10745 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
10746
10747 /* This will have to go some day... */
10748
10749 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
10750 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
10751 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
10752 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
10753 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
10754 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
10755 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
10756
10757 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
10758 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
10759 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
10760 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
10761 not it is combined with Meta. */
10762 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
10763 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
10764
10765 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10766 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
10767 {
10768 Status status_return;
10769
10770 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
10771 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10772 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10773 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10774 &status_return);
10775 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10776 {
10777 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10778 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10779 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10780 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10781 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10782 &status_return);
10783 }
10784 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
10785 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
10786 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
10787 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
10788 coding_system = Qutf_8;
10789 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10790 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10791 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10792 &status_return);
10793 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10794 {
10795 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10796 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10797 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10798 &event.xkey,
10799 copy_bufptr,
10800 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10801 &status_return);
10802 }
10803 }
10804 #endif
10805
10806 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
10807 break;
10808 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
10809 {
10810 keysym = NoSymbol;
10811 modifiers = 0;
10812 }
10813 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
10814 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
10815 abort ();
10816 }
10817 else
10818 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10819 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10820 &compose_status);
10821 #else
10822 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10823 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10824 &compose_status);
10825 #endif
10826
10827 orig_keysym = keysym;
10828
10829 if (numchars > 1)
10830 {
10831 Lisp_Object c;
10832
10833 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
10834 translations to characters. */
10835 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
10836 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
10837 {
10838 bufp->kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
10839 bufp->code = keysym;
10840 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10841 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10842 bufp->modifiers
10843 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10844 modifiers);
10845 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10846 bufp++;
10847 count++;
10848 numchars--;
10849 }
10850 /* Now non-ASCII. */
10851 else if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
10852 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
10853 Vx_keysym_table,
10854 Qnil))))
10855 {
10856 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
10857 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
10858 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
10859 bufp->code = XFASTINT (c);
10860 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10861 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10862 bufp->modifiers
10863 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10864 modifiers);
10865 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10866 bufp++;
10867 count++;
10868 numchars--;
10869 }
10870 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
10871 else if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
10872 || keysym == XK_Delete
10873 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
10874 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
10875 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
10876 #endif
10877 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
10878 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
10879 #ifdef HPUX
10880 /* This recognizes the "extended function
10881 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
10882 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
10883 mode_switch incorrectly. */
10884 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
10885 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
10886 #endif
10887 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
10888 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
10889 #endif
10890 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
10891 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
10892 #endif
10893 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
10894 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
10895 #endif
10896 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
10897 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
10898 #endif
10899 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
10900 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
10901 #endif
10902 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
10903 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
10904 #endif
10905 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
10906 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
10907 #endif
10908 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
10909 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
10910 #endif
10911 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
10912 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
10913 #endif
10914 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
10915 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
10916 #endif
10917 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
10918 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
10919 #endif
10920 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
10921 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
10922 #endif
10923 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
10924 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
10925 #endif
10926 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
10927 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
10928 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
10929 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
10930 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
10931 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
10932 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
10933 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
10934 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
10935 #endif
10936 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
10937 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
10938 #endif
10939 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
10940 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
10941 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
10942 don't have real modifiers but
10943 should be treated similarly to
10944 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
10945 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
10946 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
10947 >= XK_ISO_Lock
10948 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
10949 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
10950 #endif
10951 ))
10952 {
10953 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
10954 temp_index = 0;
10955 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
10956 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
10957 key. */
10958 bufp->kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
10959 bufp->code = keysym;
10960 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10961 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10962 bufp->modifiers
10963 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10964 modifiers);
10965 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10966 bufp++;
10967 count++;
10968 numchars--;
10969 }
10970 else if (numchars > nbytes)
10971 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
10972 register int i;
10973 register int c;
10974 int nchars, len;
10975
10976 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
10977 which depends on which X*LookupString function
10978 we used just above and the locale. */
10979 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
10980 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
10981 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
10982 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
10983 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
10984 gives us composition information. */
10985 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
10986
10987 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10988 {
10989 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
10990 / sizeof (short)))
10991 temp_index = 0;
10992 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
10993 }
10994
10995 {
10996 /* Decode the input data. */
10997 int require;
10998 unsigned char *p;
10999
11000 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
11001 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
11002 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
11003 /* We explicitely disable composition
11004 handling because key data should
11005 not contain any composition
11006 sequence. */
11007 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
11008 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
11009 nbytes, require);
11010 nbytes = coding.produced;
11011 nchars = coding.produced_char;
11012 copy_bufptr = p;
11013 }
11014
11015 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
11016 character events. */
11017 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
11018 {
11019 if (nchars == nbytes)
11020 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
11021 else
11022 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
11023 nbytes - i, len);
11024
11025 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
11026 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
11027 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
11028 bufp->code = c;
11029 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
11030 bufp->arg = Qnil;
11031 bufp->modifiers
11032 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
11033 modifiers);
11034 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
11035 bufp++;
11036 }
11037
11038 count += nchars;
11039 numchars -= nchars;
11040
11041 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
11042 break;
11043 }
11044 else
11045 abort ();
11046 }
11047 else
11048 abort ();
11049 }
11050 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11051 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
11052 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
11053 client. */
11054 break;
11055 #else
11056 goto OTHER;
11057 #endif
11058
11059 case KeyRelease:
11060 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11061 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
11062 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
11063 client. */
11064 break;
11065 #else
11066 goto OTHER;
11067 #endif
11068
11069 case EnterNotify:
11070 {
11071 int n;
11072
11073 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
11074 if (n > 0)
11075 {
11076 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11077 }
11078
11079 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
11080
11081 #if 0
11082 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
11083 {
11084 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
11085 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
11086 || !(f->auto_lower)
11087 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
11088 {
11089 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
11090 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
11091 }
11092 }
11093 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
11094 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
11095 #endif
11096
11097 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
11098 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
11099 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
11100 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
11101 goto OTHER;
11102 }
11103
11104 case FocusIn:
11105 {
11106 int n;
11107
11108 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
11109 if (n > 0)
11110 {
11111 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11112 }
11113 }
11114
11115 goto OTHER;
11116
11117 case LeaveNotify:
11118 {
11119 int n;
11120
11121 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
11122 if (n > 0)
11123 {
11124 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11125 }
11126 }
11127
11128 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
11129 if (f)
11130 {
11131 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
11132 {
11133 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
11134 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
11135 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
11136 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
11137 }
11138
11139 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
11140 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
11141 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
11142 the mouse leaves the frame. */
11143 if (any_help_event_p)
11144 {
11145 Lisp_Object frame;
11146 int n;
11147
11148 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11149 help_echo = Qnil;
11150 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
11151 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
11152 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11153 }
11154
11155 }
11156 goto OTHER;
11157
11158 case FocusOut:
11159 {
11160 int n;
11161
11162 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
11163 if (n > 0)
11164 {
11165 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11166 }
11167 }
11168
11169 goto OTHER;
11170
11171 case MotionNotify:
11172 {
11173 previous_help_echo = help_echo;
11174 help_echo = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
11175 help_echo_pos = -1;
11176
11177 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
11178 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
11179 f = last_mouse_frame;
11180 else
11181 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
11182
11183 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
11184 {
11185 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
11186 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
11187 }
11188
11189 if (f)
11190 {
11191
11192 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
11193 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
11194 {
11195 Lisp_Object window;
11196 int area;
11197
11198 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
11199 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
11200 &area, 0);
11201
11202 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
11203 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
11204 will be selected iff it is active. */
11205 if (WINDOWP(window)
11206 && !EQ (window, last_window)
11207 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
11208 && numchars > 0)
11209 {
11210 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
11211 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
11212 bufp->arg = Qnil;
11213 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
11214 }
11215
11216 last_window=window;
11217 }
11218 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
11219 }
11220 else
11221 {
11222 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11223 struct scroll_bar *bar
11224 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
11225
11226 if (bar)
11227 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
11228 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
11229
11230 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
11231 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
11232 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
11233 }
11234
11235 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo
11236 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
11237 if (!NILP (help_echo)
11238 || !NILP (previous_help_echo))
11239 {
11240 Lisp_Object frame;
11241 int n;
11242
11243 if (f)
11244 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11245 else
11246 frame = Qnil;
11247
11248 any_help_event_p = 1;
11249 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo, frame,
11250 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
11251 help_echo_pos);
11252 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
11253 }
11254
11255 goto OTHER;
11256 }
11257
11258 case ConfigureNotify:
11259 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
11260 if (f)
11261 {
11262 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11263 #ifdef USE_GTK
11264 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
11265 event.xconfigure.height);
11266 #else /* not USE_GTK */
11267 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
11268 do this one, the right one will come later.
11269 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
11270 need to reset it below. */
11271 int dont_resize =
11272 ((f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
11273 && FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) != 0);
11274 int rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, event.xconfigure.height);
11275 int columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, event.xconfigure.width);
11276 if (dont_resize)
11277 goto OTHER;
11278
11279 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
11280 is called by the code that handles resizing
11281 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
11282
11283 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
11284 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
11285 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
11286 if (columns != f->width
11287 || rows != f->height
11288 || event.xconfigure.width != f->output_data.x->pixel_width
11289 || event.xconfigure.height != f->output_data.x->pixel_height)
11290 {
11291 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
11292 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
11293 cancel_mouse_face (f);
11294 }
11295 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
11296 #endif
11297
11298 f->output_data.x->pixel_width = event.xconfigure.width;
11299 f->output_data.x->pixel_height = event.xconfigure.height;
11300
11301 #ifdef USE_GTK
11302 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
11303 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
11304 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
11305 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
11306 {
11307 #endif
11308 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
11309 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
11310 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
11311 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
11312
11313 x_check_fullscreen_move (f);
11314 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
11315 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &=
11316 ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
11317 #ifdef USE_GTK
11318 }
11319 #endif
11320 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11321 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
11322 xic_set_statusarea (f);
11323 #endif
11324
11325 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
11326 {
11327 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
11328 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
11329 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
11330 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
11331 }
11332 }
11333 goto OTHER;
11334
11335 case ButtonRelease:
11336 case ButtonPress:
11337 {
11338 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
11339 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
11340 struct input_event emacs_event;
11341 int tool_bar_p = 0;
11342
11343 emacs_event.kind = NO_EVENT;
11344 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
11345
11346 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
11347 && last_mouse_frame
11348 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
11349 f = last_mouse_frame;
11350 else
11351 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11352
11353 if (f)
11354 {
11355 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
11356 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11357 && XFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->height))
11358 {
11359 Lisp_Object window;
11360 int p, x, y;
11361
11362 x = event.xbutton.x;
11363 y = event.xbutton.y;
11364
11365 /* Set x and y. */
11366 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &p, 1);
11367 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
11368 {
11369 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, &event.xbutton);
11370 tool_bar_p = 1;
11371 }
11372 }
11373
11374 if (!tool_bar_p)
11375 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
11376 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
11377 {
11378 if (! popup_activated ())
11379 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
11380 }
11381 }
11382 else
11383 {
11384 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11385 struct scroll_bar *bar
11386 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
11387
11388 if (bar)
11389 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
11390 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
11391 }
11392
11393 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11394 {
11395 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
11396 last_mouse_frame = f;
11397 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
11398 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
11399 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
11400 the ButtonPress. */
11401 if (f != 0)
11402 f->mouse_moved = 0;
11403
11404 if (!tool_bar_p)
11405 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11406 }
11407 else
11408 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
11409
11410 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != NO_EVENT)
11411 {
11412 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
11413 bufp++;
11414 count++;
11415 numchars--;
11416 }
11417
11418 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
11419 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11420 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
11421 don't pass it to Xt right now.
11422 Instead, save it away
11423 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
11424 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
11425 if (
11426 #ifdef USE_GTK
11427 ! popup_activated ()
11428 &&
11429 #endif
11430 f && event.type == ButtonPress
11431 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
11432 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
11433 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
11434 && event.xbutton.x < f->output_data.x->pixel_width
11435 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
11436 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
11437 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
11438 {
11439 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11440 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
11441 #ifdef USE_GTK
11442 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
11443 #endif
11444 }
11445 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11446 {
11447 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11448 goto OTHER;
11449 }
11450
11451 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
11452 but I am trying to be cautious. */
11453 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
11454 {
11455 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
11456 {
11457 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
11458 if (f->output_data.x)
11459 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11460 }
11461 else
11462 goto OTHER;
11463 }
11464 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
11465 else
11466 goto OTHER;
11467 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
11468 }
11469 break;
11470
11471 case CirculateNotify:
11472 goto OTHER;
11473
11474 case CirculateRequest:
11475 goto OTHER;
11476
11477 case VisibilityNotify:
11478 goto OTHER;
11479
11480 case MappingNotify:
11481 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
11482 local cache. */
11483 switch (event.xmapping.request)
11484 {
11485 case MappingModifier:
11486 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11487 /* This is meant to fall through. */
11488 case MappingKeyboard:
11489 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
11490 }
11491 goto OTHER;
11492
11493 default:
11494 OTHER:
11495 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11496 BLOCK_INPUT;
11497 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
11498 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11499 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11500 break;
11501 }
11502
11503 goto ret;
11504
11505 out:
11506 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
11507
11508 ret:
11509 *bufp_r = bufp;
11510 *numcharsp = numchars;
11511 *eventp = event;
11512
11513 return count;
11514 }
11515
11516
11517 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
11518 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
11519 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted. */
11520 void
11521 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
11522 XEvent *event;
11523 Display *display;
11524 {
11525 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11526 struct input_event bufp[10];
11527 struct input_event *bufpp = bufp;
11528 int numchars = 10;
11529 int finish;
11530
11531 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
11532 if (dpyinfo->display == display)
11533 break;
11534
11535 if (dpyinfo)
11536 {
11537 int i, events;
11538 events = handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
11539 event,
11540 &bufpp,
11541 &numchars,
11542 &finish);
11543 for (i = 0; i < events; ++i)
11544 kbd_buffer_store_event (&bufp[i]);
11545 }
11546 }
11547
11548
11549 /* Read events coming from the X server.
11550 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
11551 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
11552
11553 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
11554 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
11555 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
11556 thus pretending to be `read'.
11557
11558 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
11559
11560 static int
11561 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
11562 register int sd;
11563 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
11564 /* register */ int numchars;
11565 int expected;
11566 {
11567 int count = 0;
11568 int nbytes = 0;
11569 XEvent event;
11570 int event_found = 0;
11571 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11572
11573 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
11574 {
11575 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
11576 return -1;
11577 }
11578
11579 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
11580 BLOCK_INPUT;
11581
11582 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
11583 input_signal_count++;
11584
11585 if (numchars <= 0)
11586 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
11587
11588 ++handling_signal;
11589
11590 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
11591 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
11592 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
11593 {
11594 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
11595 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
11596 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
11597 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
11598 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
11599 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
11600 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
11601 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
11602 #endif
11603
11604 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
11605 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
11606 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
11607 for X connections. */
11608 #ifndef SIGIO
11609 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
11610 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
11611 {
11612 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
11613 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
11614 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
11615 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
11616 }
11617 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
11618 #endif /* SIGIO */
11619 #endif
11620
11621 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
11622 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
11623 {
11624 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
11625 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
11626 }
11627
11628 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11629 BLOCK_INPUT;
11630 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
11631 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11632 #endif
11633
11634 #ifdef USE_GTK
11635 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
11636 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
11637 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
11638 that is kind of ugly, but it works. */
11639 current_dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
11640
11641 while (gtk_events_pending ())
11642 {
11643 static int nr = 0;
11644 current_count = count;
11645 current_numcharsp = &numchars;
11646 current_bufp = &bufp;
11647
11648 gtk_main_iteration ();
11649
11650 count = current_count;
11651 current_bufp = 0;
11652 current_numcharsp = 0;
11653
11654 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
11655 goto out;
11656 }
11657
11658 #else /* not USE_GTK */
11659 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
11660 {
11661 int finish;
11662
11663 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
11664
11665 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11666 {
11667 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
11668 XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
11669 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
11670 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
11671 was created. */
11672 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
11673 event.xclient.window);
11674 if (XFilterEvent (&event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None))
11675 break;
11676 }
11677 #endif
11678 event_found = 1;
11679
11680 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
11681 &event,
11682 &bufp,
11683 &numchars,
11684 &finish);
11685
11686 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
11687 goto out;
11688 }
11689 #endif /* USE_GTK */
11690 }
11691
11692 out:;
11693
11694 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
11695 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
11696 if (! event_found)
11697 {
11698 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
11699 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
11700 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
11701 x_noop_count++;
11702 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
11703 {
11704 x_noop_count=0;
11705
11706 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
11707 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
11708
11709 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
11710
11711 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
11712 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
11713 }
11714 }
11715
11716 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
11717 raise it now. */
11718 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
11719 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
11720 {
11721 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
11722 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
11723 }
11724
11725 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11726 --handling_signal;
11727 return count;
11728 }
11729
11730
11731
11732 \f
11733 /***********************************************************************
11734 Text Cursor
11735 ***********************************************************************/
11736
11737 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
11738 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
11739 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
11740 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
11741 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
11742 are window-relative. */
11743
11744 static void
11745 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1, y0, y1)
11746 struct window *w;
11747 enum glyph_row_area area;
11748 int x0, y0, x1, y1;
11749 {
11750 if (area == TEXT_AREA && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11751 {
11752 int cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
11753 int cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
11754 int cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
11755 int cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
11756
11757 if (x0 <= cx0 && (x1 < 0 || x1 >= cx1))
11758 {
11759 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
11760 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
11761 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
11762 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
11763 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
11764 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
11765 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
11766 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
11767 over the cursor image.
11768
11769 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
11770 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
11771 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
11772 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
11773 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
11774
11775 if (((y0 >= cy0 && y0 < cy1) || (y1 > cy0 && y1 < cy1))
11776 && w->current_matrix->rows[w->phys_cursor.vpos].displays_text_p)
11777 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11778 }
11779 }
11780 }
11781
11782
11783 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
11784 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
11785 WHOLE_LINE_P non-zero means include the areas used for truncation
11786 mark display and alike in the clipping rectangle.
11787
11788 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
11789 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
11790 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
11791
11792 static void
11793 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, whole_line_p)
11794 struct window *w;
11795 struct glyph_row *row;
11796 GC gc;
11797 int whole_line_p;
11798 {
11799 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11800 XRectangle clip_rect;
11801 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
11802
11803 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
11804
11805 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
11806 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
11807 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
11808 clip_rect.width = window_width;
11809 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
11810
11811 /* If clipping to the whole line, including trunc marks, extend
11812 the rectangle to the left and increase its width. */
11813 if (whole_line_p)
11814 {
11815 clip_rect.x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11816 clip_rect.width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11817 }
11818
11819 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
11820 }
11821
11822
11823 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
11824
11825 static void
11826 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
11827 struct window *w;
11828 struct glyph_row *row;
11829 {
11830 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11831 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11832 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11833 int x, y, wd, h;
11834 XGCValues xgcv;
11835 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11836 GC gc;
11837
11838 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
11839 coordinates. */
11840 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
11841 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
11842 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
11843 h = row->height - 1;
11844
11845 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
11846 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
11847 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11848 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11849 return;
11850
11851 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
11852 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
11853 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
11854 width instead. */
11855 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
11856 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
11857 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
11858 wd = min (CANON_X_UNIT (f), wd);
11859 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
11860
11861 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
11862 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
11863 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11864 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
11865 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
11866 else
11867 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11868 GCForeground, &xgcv);
11869 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
11870
11871 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
11872 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11873 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
11874 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11875 }
11876
11877
11878 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
11879
11880 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
11881 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
11882 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
11883 --gerd. */
11884
11885 static void
11886 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
11887 struct window *w;
11888 struct glyph_row *row;
11889 int width;
11890 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
11891 {
11892 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11893 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11894
11895 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
11896 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
11897 and mini-buffer. */
11898 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11899 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11900 return;
11901
11902 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
11903 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
11904 the bar might not be in the window. */
11905 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
11906 {
11907 struct glyph_row *row;
11908 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
11909 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
11910 }
11911 else
11912 {
11913 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11914 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11915 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
11916 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
11917 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
11918 XGCValues xgcv;
11919
11920 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
11921 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
11922 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
11923 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
11924 that the glyph is legible. */
11925 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
11926 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
11927 else
11928 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11929 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
11930
11931 if (gc)
11932 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
11933 else
11934 {
11935 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
11936 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
11937 }
11938
11939 if (width < 0)
11940 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
11941 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
11942
11943 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
11944 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11945
11946 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
11947 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11948 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11949 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
11950 width, row->height);
11951 else
11952 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11953 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11954 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
11955 row->height - width),
11956 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
11957 width);
11958
11959 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11960 }
11961 }
11962
11963
11964 /* Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
11965 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
11966 is is about to be rewritten. */
11967
11968 static void
11969 x_clear_cursor (w)
11970 struct window *w;
11971 {
11972 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11973 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
11974 }
11975
11976
11977 /* Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
11978 comment of x_draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
11979
11980 static void
11981 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, hl)
11982 struct window *w;
11983 struct glyph_row *row;
11984 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
11985 {
11986 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
11987 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
11988 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
11989 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
11990 {
11991 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
11992 int x1;
11993
11994 x1 = x_draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
11995 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
11996 hl, 0);
11997 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
11998
11999 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
12000 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
12001
12002 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
12003 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
12004 are redrawn. */
12005 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
12006 {
12007 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
12008 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
12009 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA);
12010
12011 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
12012 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
12013 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA);
12014 }
12015 }
12016 }
12017
12018
12019 /* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
12020
12021 static void
12022 x_erase_phys_cursor (w)
12023 struct window *w;
12024 {
12025 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
12026 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12027 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
12028 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
12029 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
12030 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
12031 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
12032 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
12033 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
12034
12035 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
12036 screen. */
12037 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
12038 goto mark_cursor_off;
12039
12040 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
12041 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
12042 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
12043 goto mark_cursor_off;
12044
12045 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
12046 can do. */
12047 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
12048 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
12049 goto mark_cursor_off;
12050
12051 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
12052 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
12053 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
12054 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
12055 goto mark_cursor_off;
12056
12057 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
12058 In this case, either x_draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
12059 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
12060 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
12061 cursor glyph at hand. */
12062 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
12063 goto mark_cursor_off;
12064
12065 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
12066 we clear the cursor. */
12067 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
12068 && w == XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
12069 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12070 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12071 && hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
12072 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12073 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12074 && hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
12075 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
12076 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
12077 mouse highlighting does not. */
12078 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos)
12079 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
12080
12081 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
12082 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
12083 {
12084 int x;
12085 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
12086
12087 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
12088 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
12089 goto mark_cursor_off;
12090
12091 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
12092
12093 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
12094 x,
12095 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
12096 cursor_row->y)),
12097 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
12098 cursor_row->visible_height,
12099 False);
12100 }
12101
12102 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
12103 if (mouse_face_here_p)
12104 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
12105 else
12106 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12107 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
12108
12109 mark_cursor_off:
12110 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
12111 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
12112 }
12113
12114
12115 /* Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
12116
12117 static int
12118 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (w)
12119 struct window *w;
12120 {
12121 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
12122 int in_mouse_face = 0;
12123
12124 if (WINDOWP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
12125 && XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window) == w)
12126 {
12127 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
12128 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
12129
12130 if (vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12131 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12132 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12133 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12134 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12135 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12136 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12137 in_mouse_face = 1;
12138 }
12139
12140 return in_mouse_face;
12141 }
12142
12143
12144 /* Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
12145 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
12146 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
12147
12148 void
12149 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
12150 struct window *w;
12151 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
12152 {
12153 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
12154 int new_cursor_type;
12155 int new_cursor_width;
12156 int active_cursor;
12157 struct glyph_matrix *current_glyphs;
12158 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
12159 struct glyph *glyph;
12160
12161 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
12162 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
12163 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
12164 window. */
12165 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
12166 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
12167 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
12168 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
12169 return;
12170
12171 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
12172 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
12173 return;
12174
12175 current_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
12176 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_glyphs, vpos);
12177 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
12178
12179 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
12180 display the cursor. */
12181 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
12182 {
12183 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
12184 return;
12185 }
12186
12187 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
12188
12189 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
12190 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
12191
12192 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
12193 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
12194 erase it. */
12195 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
12196 && (!on
12197 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
12198 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
12199 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
12200 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
12201 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
12202 x_erase_phys_cursor (w);
12203
12204 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
12205 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
12206 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
12207 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
12208 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
12209 if (on)
12210 {
12211 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
12212 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
12213
12214 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
12215 of them may need the information. */
12216 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
12217 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
12218 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
12219 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
12220 w->phys_cursor_type = new_cursor_type;
12221 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
12222
12223 switch (new_cursor_type)
12224 {
12225 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
12226 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
12227 break;
12228
12229 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
12230 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
12231 break;
12232
12233 case BAR_CURSOR:
12234 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
12235 break;
12236
12237 case HBAR_CURSOR:
12238 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
12239 break;
12240
12241 case NO_CURSOR:
12242 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
12243 break;
12244
12245 default:
12246 abort ();
12247 }
12248
12249 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12250 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
12251 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
12252 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
12253 #endif
12254 }
12255
12256 #ifndef XFlush
12257 if (updating_frame != f)
12258 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12259 #endif
12260 }
12261
12262
12263 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it. X and Y are window
12264 relative pixel coordinates. HPOS and VPOS are glyph matrix
12265 positions. If W is not the selected window, display a hollow
12266 cursor. ON non-zero means display the cursor at X, Y which
12267 correspond to HPOS, VPOS, otherwise it is cleared. */
12268
12269 void
12270 x_display_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
12271 struct window *w;
12272 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
12273 {
12274 BLOCK_INPUT;
12275 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y);
12276 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12277 }
12278
12279
12280 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
12281 Don't change the cursor's position. */
12282
12283 void
12284 x_update_cursor (f, on_p)
12285 struct frame *f;
12286 int on_p;
12287 {
12288 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
12289 }
12290
12291
12292 /* Call x_update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
12293 in the window tree rooted at W. */
12294
12295 static void
12296 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (w, on_p)
12297 struct window *w;
12298 int on_p;
12299 {
12300 while (w)
12301 {
12302 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
12303 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
12304 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
12305 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
12306 else
12307 x_update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
12308
12309 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
12310 }
12311 }
12312
12313
12314 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
12315 of ON. */
12316
12317 static void
12318 x_update_window_cursor (w, on)
12319 struct window *w;
12320 int on;
12321 {
12322 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
12323 of being deleted. */
12324 if (w->current_matrix)
12325 {
12326 BLOCK_INPUT;
12327 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
12328 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
12329 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12330 }
12331 }
12332
12333
12334
12335 \f
12336 /* Icons. */
12337
12338 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
12339
12340 int
12341 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
12342 struct frame *f;
12343 Lisp_Object file;
12344 {
12345 int bitmap_id;
12346
12347 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
12348 return 1;
12349
12350 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
12351 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
12352 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
12353 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
12354
12355 if (STRINGP (file))
12356 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
12357 else
12358 {
12359 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
12360 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
12361 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
12362 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
12363 gnu_width, gnu_height);
12364
12365 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
12366 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
12367 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
12368 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
12369 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
12370
12371 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
12372 }
12373
12374 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
12375 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
12376
12377 return 0;
12378 }
12379
12380
12381 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
12382 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
12383
12384 int
12385 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
12386 struct frame *f;
12387 char *icon_name;
12388 {
12389 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
12390 return 1;
12391
12392 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
12393 {
12394 XTextProperty text;
12395 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
12396 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
12397 text.format = 8;
12398 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
12399 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12400 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
12401 &text);
12402 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12403 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), &text);
12404 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12405 }
12406 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
12407 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
12408 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
12409
12410 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
12411 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
12412 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
12413 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
12414
12415 return 0;
12416 }
12417 \f
12418 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
12419
12420 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
12421 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
12422
12423 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
12424
12425 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
12426 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
12427 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
12428
12429 static void
12430 x_error_catcher (display, error)
12431 Display *display;
12432 XErrorEvent *error;
12433 {
12434 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
12435 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
12436 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
12437 }
12438
12439 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
12440 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
12441 operating on.
12442
12443 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
12444 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
12445 stored in x_error_message_string.
12446
12447 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
12448 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
12449
12450 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
12451
12452 void x_check_errors ();
12453 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
12454
12455 int
12456 x_catch_errors (dpy)
12457 Display *dpy;
12458 {
12459 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
12460
12461 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
12462 XSync (dpy, False);
12463
12464 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
12465 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
12466 x_error_message_string));
12467
12468 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
12469 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
12470
12471 return count;
12472 }
12473
12474 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
12475
12476 static Lisp_Object
12477 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
12478 Lisp_Object old_val;
12479 {
12480 Lisp_Object first;
12481
12482 first = XCAR (old_val);
12483
12484 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
12485
12486 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
12487 return Qnil;
12488 }
12489
12490 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
12491 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
12492 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
12493
12494 void
12495 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
12496 Display *dpy;
12497 char *format;
12498 {
12499 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12500 XSync (dpy, False);
12501
12502 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
12503 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
12504 }
12505
12506 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
12507 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12508
12509 int
12510 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
12511 Display *dpy;
12512 {
12513 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12514 XSync (dpy, False);
12515
12516 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
12517 }
12518
12519 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12520
12521 void
12522 x_clear_errors (dpy)
12523 Display *dpy;
12524 {
12525 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
12526 }
12527
12528 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
12529 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
12530 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
12531 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
12532
12533 void
12534 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
12535 Display *dpy;
12536 int count;
12537 {
12538 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
12539 }
12540
12541 #if 0
12542 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
12543 x_trace_wire ()
12544 {
12545 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
12546 }
12547 #endif /* ! 0 */
12548
12549 \f
12550 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
12551 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
12552 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
12553 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
12554 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
12555
12556 static SIGTYPE
12557 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
12558 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
12559 {
12560 #ifdef USG
12561 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
12562 must reestablish each time */
12563 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
12564 #endif /* USG */
12565 }
12566
12567 \f
12568 /************************************************************************
12569 Handling X errors
12570 ************************************************************************/
12571
12572 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
12573
12574 static char *error_msg;
12575
12576 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
12577 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
12578 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
12579
12580 static void
12581 x_fatal_error_signal ()
12582 {
12583 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12584 exit (70);
12585 }
12586
12587 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
12588 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
12589
12590 static SIGTYPE
12591 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
12592 Display *dpy;
12593 char *error_message;
12594 {
12595 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
12596 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12597 int count;
12598
12599 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
12600 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
12601 handling_signal = 0;
12602
12603 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
12604 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
12605 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
12606 the original message here. */
12607 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
12608
12609 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
12610 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
12611 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
12612
12613 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12614 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
12615 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12616
12617 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
12618 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
12619
12620 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
12621 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
12622 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
12623
12624 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12625 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
12626 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
12627 if (dpyinfo)
12628 {
12629 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
12630 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
12631 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
12632 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
12633 }
12634 #endif
12635
12636 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
12637 if (dpyinfo)
12638 dpyinfo->display = 0;
12639
12640 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
12641 that are on the dead display. */
12642 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12643 {
12644 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
12645 minibuf_frame
12646 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
12647 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12648 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
12649 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
12650 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
12651 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12652 }
12653
12654 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
12655 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
12656 for another frame that we need to delete. */
12657 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12658 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12659 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
12660 {
12661 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
12662 trying to find a replacement. */
12663 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
12664 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12665 }
12666
12667 if (dpyinfo)
12668 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
12669
12670 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
12671
12672 if (x_display_list == 0)
12673 {
12674 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12675 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
12676 exit (70);
12677 }
12678
12679 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
12680 #ifdef SIGIO
12681 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
12682 #endif
12683 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
12684 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12685
12686 clear_waiting_for_input ();
12687 error ("%s", error_msg);
12688 }
12689
12690
12691 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
12692 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
12693 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12694
12695 static void
12696 x_error_quitter (display, error)
12697 Display *display;
12698 XErrorEvent *error;
12699 {
12700 char buf[256], buf1[356];
12701
12702 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
12703 original error handler. */
12704
12705 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
12706 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
12707 buf, error->request_code);
12708 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
12709 }
12710
12711
12712 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
12713 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
12714
12715 static int
12716 x_error_handler (display, error)
12717 Display *display;
12718 XErrorEvent *error;
12719 {
12720 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
12721 x_error_catcher (display, error);
12722 else
12723 x_error_quitter (display, error);
12724 return 0;
12725 }
12726
12727 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
12728 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
12729 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12730
12731 static int
12732 x_io_error_quitter (display)
12733 Display *display;
12734 {
12735 char buf[256];
12736
12737 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
12738 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
12739 return 0;
12740 }
12741 \f
12742 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
12743
12744 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
12745 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
12746 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
12747 The return value shows which font we chose. */
12748
12749 Lisp_Object
12750 x_new_font (f, fontname)
12751 struct frame *f;
12752 register char *fontname;
12753 {
12754 struct font_info *fontp
12755 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
12756
12757 if (!fontp)
12758 return Qnil;
12759
12760 f->output_data.x->font = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
12761 f->output_data.x->baseline_offset = fontp->baseline_offset;
12762 f->output_data.x->fontset = -1;
12763
12764 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
12765
12766 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
12767 if (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width > 0)
12768 {
12769 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12770 f->scroll_bar_cols = (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width + wid-1) / wid;
12771 }
12772 else
12773 {
12774 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12775 f->scroll_bar_cols = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
12776 }
12777
12778 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
12779 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
12780 {
12781 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
12782 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12783 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
12784 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12785 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
12786 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12787
12788 frame_update_line_height (f);
12789
12790 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
12791 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
12792 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
12793 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
12794 x_set_window_size (f, 0, f->width, f->height);
12795 }
12796 else
12797 /* If we are setting a new frame's font for the first time,
12798 there are no faces yet, so this font's height is the line height. */
12799 f->output_data.x->line_height = FONT_HEIGHT (f->output_data.x->font);
12800
12801 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
12802 }
12803
12804 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
12805 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
12806 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
12807 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
12808
12809 Lisp_Object
12810 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
12811 struct frame *f;
12812 char *fontsetname;
12813 {
12814 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
12815 Lisp_Object result;
12816
12817 if (fontset < 0)
12818 return Qnil;
12819
12820 if (f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
12821 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
12822 to do. */
12823 return fontset_name (fontset);
12824
12825 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
12826
12827 if (!STRINGP (result))
12828 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
12829 return Qnil;
12830
12831 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
12832 f->output_data.x->fontset = fontset;
12833
12834 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12835 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
12836 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
12837 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
12838 #endif
12839
12840 return build_string (fontsetname);
12841 }
12842
12843 /* Compute actual fringe widths */
12844
12845 void
12846 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, redraw)
12847 struct frame *f;
12848 int redraw;
12849 {
12850 int o_left = f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width;
12851 int o_right = f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width;
12852 int o_cols = f->output_data.x->fringe_cols;
12853
12854 Lisp_Object left_fringe = Fassq (Qleft_fringe, f->param_alist);
12855 Lisp_Object right_fringe = Fassq (Qright_fringe, f->param_alist);
12856 int left_fringe_width, right_fringe_width;
12857
12858 if (!NILP (left_fringe))
12859 left_fringe = Fcdr (left_fringe);
12860 if (!NILP (right_fringe))
12861 right_fringe = Fcdr (right_fringe);
12862
12863 left_fringe_width = ((NILP (left_fringe) || !INTEGERP (left_fringe)) ? 8 :
12864 XINT (left_fringe));
12865 right_fringe_width = ((NILP (right_fringe) || !INTEGERP (right_fringe)) ? 8 :
12866 XINT (right_fringe));
12867
12868 if (left_fringe_width || right_fringe_width)
12869 {
12870 int left_wid = left_fringe_width >= 0 ? left_fringe_width : -left_fringe_width;
12871 int right_wid = right_fringe_width >= 0 ? right_fringe_width : -right_fringe_width;
12872 int conf_wid = left_wid + right_wid;
12873 int font_wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12874 int cols = (left_wid + right_wid + font_wid-1) / font_wid;
12875 int real_wid = cols * font_wid;
12876 if (left_wid && right_wid)
12877 {
12878 if (left_fringe_width < 0)
12879 {
12880 /* Left fringe width is fixed, adjust right fringe if necessary */
12881 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid;
12882 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid - left_wid;
12883 }
12884 else if (right_fringe_width < 0)
12885 {
12886 /* Right fringe width is fixed, adjust left fringe if necessary */
12887 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid - right_wid;
12888 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid;
12889 }
12890 else
12891 {
12892 /* Adjust both fringes with an equal amount.
12893 Note that we are doing integer arithmetic here, so don't
12894 lose a pixel if the total width is an odd number. */
12895 int fill = real_wid - conf_wid;
12896 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid + fill/2;
12897 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid + fill - fill/2;
12898 }
12899 }
12900 else if (left_fringe_width)
12901 {
12902 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid;
12903 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12904 }
12905 else
12906 {
12907 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12908 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid;
12909 }
12910 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = cols;
12911 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = real_wid;
12912 }
12913 else
12914 {
12915 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12916 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12917 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = 0;
12918 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = 0;
12919 }
12920
12921 if (redraw && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12922 if (o_left != f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width ||
12923 o_right != f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width ||
12924 o_cols != f->output_data.x->fringe_cols)
12925 redraw_frame (f);
12926 }
12927 \f
12928 /***********************************************************************
12929 X Input Methods
12930 ***********************************************************************/
12931
12932 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12933
12934 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12935
12936 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
12937 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
12938 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
12939
12940 static void
12941 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
12942 XIM xim;
12943 XPointer client_data;
12944 XPointer call_data;
12945 {
12946 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
12947 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12948
12949 BLOCK_INPUT;
12950
12951 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
12952 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12953 {
12954 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12955 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
12956 {
12957 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
12958 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
12959 {
12960 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
12961 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
12962 }
12963 }
12964 }
12965
12966 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
12967 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12968 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
12969 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12970 }
12971
12972 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
12973
12974 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12975 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
12976 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
12977 #endif
12978
12979 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
12980 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
12981
12982 static void
12983 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
12984 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12985 char *resource_name;
12986 {
12987 #ifdef USE_XIM
12988 XIM xim;
12989
12990 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
12991 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
12992
12993 if (xim)
12994 {
12995 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12996 XIMCallback destroy;
12997 #endif
12998
12999 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
13000 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
13001
13002 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
13003 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
13004 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
13005 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
13006 #endif
13007 }
13008
13009 #else /* not USE_XIM */
13010 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
13011 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
13012 }
13013
13014
13015 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
13016
13017 struct xim_inst_t
13018 {
13019 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
13020 char *resource_name;
13021 };
13022
13023 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
13024 server is available. DISPLAY is teh display of the XIM.
13025 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
13026 when the callback was registered. */
13027
13028 static void
13029 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
13030 Display *display;
13031 XPointer client_data;
13032 XPointer call_data;
13033 {
13034 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
13035 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
13036
13037 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
13038 if (dpyinfo->xim)
13039 return;
13040
13041 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
13042
13043 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
13044 as they have no XIC. */
13045 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
13046 {
13047 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13048
13049 BLOCK_INPUT;
13050 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13051 {
13052 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13053
13054 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
13055 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
13056 {
13057 create_frame_xic (f);
13058 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
13059 xic_set_statusarea (f);
13060 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
13061 {
13062 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
13063 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
13064 }
13065 }
13066 }
13067
13068 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13069 }
13070 }
13071
13072 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
13073
13074
13075 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
13076 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
13077 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
13078 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
13079
13080 static void
13081 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
13082 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
13083 char *resource_name;
13084 {
13085 #ifdef USE_XIM
13086 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
13087 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
13088 int len;
13089
13090 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
13091 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
13092 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
13093 len = strlen (resource_name);
13094 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
13095 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
13096 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
13097 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
13098 xim_instantiate_callback,
13099 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
13100 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
13101 Tru64, at least. */
13102 (XPointer) xim_inst);
13103 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
13104 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
13105 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
13106 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
13107
13108 #else /* not USE_XIM */
13109 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
13110 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
13111 }
13112
13113
13114 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
13115
13116 static void
13117 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
13118 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
13119 {
13120 #ifdef USE_XIM
13121 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
13122 if (dpyinfo->display)
13123 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
13124 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
13125 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
13126 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
13127 if (dpyinfo->display)
13128 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
13129 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
13130 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
13131 #endif /* USE_XIM */
13132 }
13133
13134 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
13135
13136
13137 \f
13138 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
13139 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
13140
13141 void
13142 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
13143 struct frame *f;
13144 {
13145 Window child;
13146 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
13147 int flags = f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags;
13148 int this_window;
13149
13150 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
13151 is already for the top-left corner. */
13152 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
13153 return;
13154
13155 this_window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
13156
13157 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
13158 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
13159 But do this only if we will need the results. */
13160 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
13161 {
13162 int count;
13163
13164 BLOCK_INPUT;
13165 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13166 while (1)
13167 {
13168 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13169 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13170
13171 /* From-window, to-window. */
13172 this_window,
13173 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
13174
13175 /* From-position, to-position. */
13176 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
13177
13178 /* Child of win. */
13179 &child);
13180 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
13181 {
13182 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
13183 Window *newchildren;
13184 unsigned int nchildren;
13185
13186 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
13187 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
13188 break;
13189
13190 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
13191
13192 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
13193 }
13194 else
13195 break;
13196 }
13197
13198 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
13199 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13200 }
13201
13202 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
13203 position that fits on the screen. */
13204 if (flags & XNegative)
13205 f->output_data.x->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
13206 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width - win_x
13207 - PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
13208 + f->output_data.x->left_pos);
13209
13210 {
13211 int height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13212
13213 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
13214 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
13215 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
13216
13217 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
13218 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
13219 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
13220 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
13221 is right, though.
13222
13223 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
13224 2000-12-01, gerd. */
13225
13226 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
13227 #endif
13228
13229 if (flags & YNegative)
13230 f->output_data.x->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
13231 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width
13232 - win_y
13233 - height
13234 + f->output_data.x->top_pos);
13235 }
13236
13237 /* The left_pos and top_pos
13238 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
13239 so the flags should correspond. */
13240 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
13241 }
13242
13243 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
13244 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
13245 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
13246 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
13247 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
13248
13249 void
13250 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
13251 struct frame *f;
13252 register int xoff, yoff;
13253 int change_gravity;
13254 {
13255 int modified_top, modified_left;
13256
13257 if (change_gravity > 0)
13258 {
13259 f->output_data.x->top_pos = yoff;
13260 f->output_data.x->left_pos = xoff;
13261 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
13262 if (xoff < 0)
13263 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
13264 if (yoff < 0)
13265 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
13266 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
13267 }
13268 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
13269
13270 BLOCK_INPUT;
13271 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
13272
13273 modified_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13274 modified_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13275 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
13276 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
13277 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
13278 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
13279 if (change_gravity != 0)
13280 {
13281 modified_left += f->output_data.x->border_width;
13282 modified_top += f->output_data.x->border_width;
13283 }
13284 #endif
13285
13286 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13287 modified_left, modified_top);
13288 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13289 }
13290
13291 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
13292 If so needed, resize the frame. */
13293 static void
13294 x_check_fullscreen (f)
13295 struct frame *f;
13296 {
13297 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
13298 {
13299 int width, height, ign;
13300
13301 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
13302 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
13303
13304 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
13305
13306 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
13307 when setting WM manager hints.
13308 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
13309 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
13310 if (f->width != width || f->height != height)
13311 {
13312 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
13313 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
13314 cancel_mouse_face (f);
13315
13316 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
13317 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
13318
13319 }
13320 }
13321 }
13322
13323 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
13324 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
13325 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
13326 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
13327 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
13328 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
13329 static void
13330 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
13331 struct frame *f;
13332 {
13333 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
13334 {
13335 int expect_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13336 int expect_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13337
13338 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
13339 expect_top = 0;
13340 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
13341 expect_left = 0;
13342
13343 if (expect_top != f->output_data.x->top_pos
13344 || expect_left != f->output_data.x->left_pos)
13345 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
13346
13347 /* Just do this once */
13348 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
13349 }
13350 }
13351
13352
13353 /* Calculate fullscreen size. Return in *TOP_POS and *LEFT_POS the
13354 wanted positions of the WM window (not emacs window).
13355 Return in *WIDTH and *HEIGHT the wanted width and height of Emacs
13356 window (FRAME_X_WINDOW).
13357 */
13358 void
13359 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, width, height, top_pos, left_pos)
13360 struct frame *f;
13361 int *width;
13362 int *height;
13363 int *top_pos;
13364 int *left_pos;
13365 {
13366 int newwidth = f->width, newheight = f->height;
13367
13368 *top_pos = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13369 *left_pos = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13370
13371 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
13372 {
13373 int ph;
13374
13375 ph = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height;
13376 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
13377 ph = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, newheight)
13378 - f->output_data.x->y_pixels_diff;
13379 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
13380 *top_pos = 0;
13381 }
13382
13383 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
13384 {
13385 int pw;
13386
13387 pw = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width;
13388 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
13389 pw = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, newwidth)
13390 - f->output_data.x->x_pixels_diff;
13391 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
13392 *left_pos = 0;
13393 }
13394
13395 *width = newwidth;
13396 *height = newheight;
13397 }
13398
13399
13400 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
13401 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
13402 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
13403 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
13404
13405 static void
13406 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
13407 struct frame *f;
13408 int change_gravity;
13409 int cols, rows;
13410 {
13411 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
13412
13413 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
13414 f->output_data.x->vertical_scroll_bar_extra
13415 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
13416 ? 0
13417 : FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0
13418 ? FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
13419 : (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font)));
13420
13421 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
13422
13423 pixelwidth = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
13424 pixelheight = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
13425
13426 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
13427 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
13428
13429 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
13430 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13431 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
13432
13433 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
13434 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
13435 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
13436 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
13437
13438 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
13439 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
13440 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
13441 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
13442 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
13443
13444 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
13445 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
13446 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
13447 PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
13448 PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
13449
13450 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
13451 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
13452 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
13453 we have to make sure to do it here. */
13454 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
13455
13456 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13457 }
13458
13459
13460 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
13461 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
13462 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
13463 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
13464
13465 void
13466 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
13467 struct frame *f;
13468 int change_gravity;
13469 int cols, rows;
13470 {
13471 BLOCK_INPUT;
13472
13473 #ifdef USE_GTK
13474 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
13475 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
13476 else
13477 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13478 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
13479
13480 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
13481 {
13482 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
13483 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
13484 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
13485 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
13486 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
13487 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
13488 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
13489 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
13490 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
13491 }
13492 else
13493 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13494
13495 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13496
13497 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13498
13499 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13500
13501 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
13502 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
13503
13504 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
13505 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
13506 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
13507 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
13508 cancel_mouse_face (f);
13509
13510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13511 }
13512 \f
13513 /* Mouse warping. */
13514
13515 void
13516 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
13517 struct frame *f;
13518 int x, y;
13519 {
13520 int pix_x, pix_y;
13521
13522 pix_x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, x) + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font) / 2;
13523 pix_y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, y) + f->output_data.x->line_height / 2;
13524
13525 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
13526 if (pix_x > PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
13527
13528 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
13529 if (pix_y > PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13530
13531 BLOCK_INPUT;
13532
13533 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13534 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13536 }
13537
13538 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
13539
13540 void
13541 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
13542 struct frame *f;
13543 int pix_x, pix_y;
13544 {
13545 BLOCK_INPUT;
13546
13547 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13548 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13550 }
13551 \f
13552 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
13553
13554 void
13555 x_focus_on_frame (f)
13556 struct frame *f;
13557 {
13558 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
13559 x_raise_frame (f);
13560 #endif
13561 #if 0
13562 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
13563 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
13564 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
13565 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13566 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13567 #endif /* ! 0 */
13568 }
13569
13570 void
13571 x_unfocus_frame (f)
13572 struct frame *f;
13573 {
13574 #if 0
13575 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
13576 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
13577 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
13578 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13579 #endif /* ! 0 */
13580 }
13581
13582 /* Raise frame F. */
13583
13584 void
13585 x_raise_frame (f)
13586 struct frame *f;
13587 {
13588 if (f->async_visible)
13589 {
13590 BLOCK_INPUT;
13591 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13592 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13593 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13594 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13595 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13596 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13598 }
13599 }
13600
13601 /* Lower frame F. */
13602
13603 void
13604 x_lower_frame (f)
13605 struct frame *f;
13606 {
13607 if (f->async_visible)
13608 {
13609 BLOCK_INPUT;
13610 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13611 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13612 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13613 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13614 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13615 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13616 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13617 }
13618 }
13619
13620 static void
13621 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
13622 FRAME_PTR f;
13623 int raise_flag;
13624 {
13625 if (raise_flag)
13626 x_raise_frame (f);
13627 else
13628 x_lower_frame (f);
13629 }
13630 \f
13631 /* Change of visibility. */
13632
13633 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
13634 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
13635 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
13636 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
13637 but it will become visible later when the window manager
13638 finishes with it. */
13639
13640 void
13641 x_make_frame_visible (f)
13642 struct frame *f;
13643 {
13644 Lisp_Object type;
13645 int original_top, original_left;
13646 int retry_count = 2;
13647
13648 retry:
13649
13650 BLOCK_INPUT;
13651
13652 type = x_icon_type (f);
13653 if (!NILP (type))
13654 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13655
13656 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13657 {
13658 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
13659 call x_set_offset a second time
13660 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
13661 before the window gets really visible. */
13662 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13663 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
13664 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13665
13666 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
13667
13668 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13669 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
13670 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13671 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13672 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13673 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13674 #ifdef USE_GTK
13675 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
13676 #else
13677 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13678 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
13679 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13680 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
13681 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
13682 to come back ok without this. */
13683 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
13684 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13685 #endif
13686 }
13687
13688 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13689
13690 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
13691 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
13692 so that incoming events are handled. */
13693 {
13694 Lisp_Object frame;
13695 int count;
13696 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
13697 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
13698 will set it when they are handled. */
13699 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
13700
13701 original_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13702 original_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13703
13704 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
13705 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13706
13707 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
13708
13709 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
13710 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
13711 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
13712 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
13713
13714 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
13715 because the window manager may choose the position
13716 and we don't want to override it. */
13717
13718 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13719 && f->output_data.x->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
13720 && previously_visible)
13721 {
13722 Drawable rootw;
13723 int x, y;
13724 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
13725
13726 BLOCK_INPUT;
13727
13728 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
13729 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
13730 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
13731 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
13732 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
13733 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
13734 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
13735 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13736 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
13737
13738 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
13739 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13740 original_left, original_top);
13741
13742 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13743 }
13744
13745 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
13746
13747 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
13748 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
13749 MapNotify at all.. */
13750 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
13751 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
13752 {
13753 /* Force processing of queued events. */
13754 x_sync (f);
13755
13756 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
13757 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
13758 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
13759 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
13760 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
13761 probably a bug. */
13762 if (input_polling_used ())
13763 {
13764 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
13765 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
13766 handler reset it. */
13767 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
13768 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
13769 poll_suppress_count = 1;
13770 poll_for_input_1 ();
13771 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
13772 }
13773
13774 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
13775 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13776 }
13777
13778 /* 2000-09-28: In
13779
13780 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
13781 (iconify-frame f)
13782 (raise-frame f))
13783
13784 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
13785 FreeBSD, Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
13786 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
13787 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
13788
13789 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
13790 goto retry;
13791 }
13792 }
13793
13794 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
13795
13796 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
13797
13798 void
13799 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
13800 struct frame *f;
13801 {
13802 Window window;
13803
13804 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13805 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
13806 window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13807 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13808 window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13809 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13810
13811 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13812 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13813 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13814
13815 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
13816 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
13817 return;
13818 #endif
13819
13820 BLOCK_INPUT;
13821
13822 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
13823 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
13824 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
13825 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
13826 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
13827 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
13828
13829 #ifdef USE_GTK
13830 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
13831 {
13832 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
13833 goto out;
13834 }
13835 #endif
13836
13837 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13838
13839 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
13840 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
13841 {
13842 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13843 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
13844 }
13845 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13846
13847 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
13848 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13849 {
13850 XEvent unmap;
13851
13852 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
13853 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
13854 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13855 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
13856 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13857 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13858 False,
13859 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
13860 &unmap))
13861 {
13862 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13863 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
13864 }
13865 }
13866
13867 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
13868 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
13869 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13870
13871 out:
13872 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
13873 just by the event that we get from the server.
13874 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
13875 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
13876 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
13877 f->visible = 0;
13878 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
13879 f->async_visible = 0;
13880 f->async_iconified = 0;
13881
13882 x_sync (f);
13883
13884 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13885 }
13886
13887 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
13888
13889 void
13890 x_iconify_frame (f)
13891 struct frame *f;
13892 {
13893 int result;
13894 Lisp_Object type;
13895
13896 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13897 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13898 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13899
13900 if (f->async_iconified)
13901 return;
13902
13903 BLOCK_INPUT;
13904
13905 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13906
13907 type = x_icon_type (f);
13908 if (!NILP (type))
13909 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13910
13911 #ifdef USE_GTK
13912 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
13913 {
13914 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13915 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
13916
13917 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
13918 f->iconified = 1;
13919 f->visible = 1;
13920 f->async_iconified = 1;
13921 f->async_visible = 0;
13922 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13923 return;
13924 }
13925 #endif
13926
13927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13928
13929 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13930 {
13931 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13932 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13933 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13934 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13935 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
13936 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
13937 so we have to record it here. */
13938 f->iconified = 1;
13939 f->visible = 1;
13940 f->async_iconified = 1;
13941 f->async_visible = 0;
13942 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13943 return;
13944 }
13945
13946 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13947 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
13948 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
13949 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13950
13951 if (!result)
13952 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13953
13954 f->async_iconified = 1;
13955 f->async_visible = 0;
13956
13957
13958 BLOCK_INPUT;
13959 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13960 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13961 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13962
13963 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
13964 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
13965 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
13966 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13967
13968 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
13969 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
13970
13971 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
13972 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
13973 {
13974 XEvent message;
13975
13976 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13977 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
13978 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
13979 message.xclient.format = 32;
13980 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
13981
13982 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13983 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13984 False,
13985 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
13986 &message))
13987 {
13988 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13989 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13990 }
13991 }
13992
13993 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
13994 IconicState. */
13995 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13996
13997 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13998 {
13999 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
14000 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
14001 }
14002
14003 f->async_iconified = 1;
14004 f->async_visible = 0;
14005
14006 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14007 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14008 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14009 }
14010
14011 \f
14012 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
14013
14014 void
14015 x_free_frame_resources (f)
14016 struct frame *f;
14017 {
14018 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14019 Lisp_Object bar;
14020 struct scroll_bar *b;
14021
14022 BLOCK_INPUT;
14023
14024 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
14025 commands to the X server. */
14026 if (dpyinfo->display)
14027 {
14028 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
14029 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
14030
14031 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14032 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
14033 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
14034 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
14035 toolkit scroll bars. */
14036 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
14037 {
14038 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
14039 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
14040 }
14041 #endif
14042
14043 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
14044 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
14045 free_frame_xic (f);
14046 #endif
14047
14048 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14049 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
14050 {
14051 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
14052 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
14053 }
14054 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
14055 we are using a toolkit. */
14056 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
14057 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
14058
14059 free_frame_menubar (f);
14060 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14061
14062 #ifdef USE_GTK
14063 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
14064 frames. We must check and free both types. */
14065 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
14066 {
14067 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
14068 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
14069 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
14070 }
14071 #endif /* USE_GTK */
14072
14073 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
14074 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
14075 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14076
14077 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
14078 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
14079 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
14080 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
14081 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
14082 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
14083
14084 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
14085 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
14086 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
14087 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
14088 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
14089 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
14090 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
14091 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
14092 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
14093 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
14094 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
14095 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
14096 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
14097 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
14098 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
14099
14100 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
14101 free_frame_faces (f);
14102
14103 x_free_gcs (f);
14104 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14105 }
14106
14107 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
14108 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
14109
14110 xfree (f->output_data.x);
14111 f->output_data.x = NULL;
14112
14113 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
14114 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
14115 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
14116 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
14117 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
14118 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
14119
14120 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
14121 {
14122 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
14123 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
14124 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
14125 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
14126 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
14127 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
14128 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
14129 }
14130
14131 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14132 }
14133
14134
14135 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
14136
14137 void
14138 x_destroy_window (f)
14139 struct frame *f;
14140 {
14141 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14142
14143 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
14144 commands to the X server. */
14145 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
14146 x_free_frame_resources (f);
14147
14148 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
14149 }
14150
14151 \f
14152 /* Setting window manager hints. */
14153
14154 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
14155 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
14156 that the window now has.
14157 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
14158 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
14159 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
14160
14161 #ifndef USE_GTK
14162 void
14163 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
14164 struct frame *f;
14165 long flags;
14166 int user_position;
14167 {
14168 XSizeHints size_hints;
14169
14170 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14171 Arg al[2];
14172 int ac = 0;
14173 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
14174 #endif
14175
14176 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
14177
14178 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
14179 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
14180
14181 size_hints.x = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
14182 size_hints.y = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
14183
14184 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14185 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
14186 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
14187 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
14188 size_hints.height = widget_height;
14189 size_hints.width = widget_width;
14190 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14191 size_hints.height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
14192 size_hints.width = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
14193 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14194
14195 size_hints.width_inc = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
14196 size_hints.height_inc = f->output_data.x->line_height;
14197 size_hints.max_width
14198 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
14199 size_hints.max_height
14200 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
14201
14202 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
14203
14204 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
14205 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
14206 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14207 {
14208 int base_width, base_height;
14209 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
14210
14211 base_width = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
14212 base_height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
14213
14214 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
14215
14216 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
14217 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
14218 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
14219 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
14220 zero-row, zero-column frame.
14221
14222 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
14223 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
14224 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
14225
14226 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
14227 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
14228 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
14229 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
14230 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
14231 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
14232 #else
14233 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
14234 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
14235 #endif
14236 }
14237
14238 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
14239 if (flags)
14240 {
14241 size_hints.flags |= flags;
14242 goto no_read;
14243 }
14244 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14245
14246 {
14247 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
14248 long supplied_return;
14249 int value;
14250
14251 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
14252 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
14253 &supplied_return);
14254 #else
14255 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
14256 #endif
14257
14258 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14259 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
14260 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
14261 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
14262 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
14263 #endif
14264
14265 if (flags)
14266 size_hints.flags |= flags;
14267 else
14268 {
14269 if (value == 0)
14270 hints.flags = 0;
14271 if (hints.flags & PSize)
14272 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
14273 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
14274 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
14275 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
14276 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
14277 if (hints.flags & USSize)
14278 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
14279 }
14280 }
14281
14282 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14283 no_read:
14284 #endif
14285
14286 #ifdef PWinGravity
14287 size_hints.win_gravity = f->output_data.x->win_gravity;
14288 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
14289
14290 if (user_position)
14291 {
14292 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
14293 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
14294 }
14295 #endif /* PWinGravity */
14296
14297 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
14298 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
14299 #else
14300 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
14301 #endif
14302 }
14303 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
14304
14305 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
14306
14307 void
14308 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
14309 struct frame *f;
14310 int state;
14311 {
14312 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14313 Arg al[1];
14314
14315 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
14316 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
14317 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14318 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
14319
14320 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
14321 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
14322
14323 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
14324 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14325 }
14326
14327 void
14328 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
14329 struct frame *f;
14330 int pixmap_id;
14331 {
14332 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
14333
14334 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14335 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
14336 #endif
14337
14338 if (pixmap_id > 0)
14339 {
14340 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
14341 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
14342 }
14343 else
14344 {
14345 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
14346 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
14347 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
14348 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
14349 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
14350 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
14351 best to explicitly give up. */
14352 #if 0
14353 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
14354 #else
14355 return;
14356 #endif
14357 }
14358
14359 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
14360
14361 {
14362 Arg al[1];
14363 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
14364 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
14365 }
14366
14367 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14368
14369 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
14370 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
14371
14372 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14373 }
14374
14375 void
14376 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
14377 struct frame *f;
14378 int icon_x, icon_y;
14379 {
14380 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14381 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
14382 #else
14383 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
14384 #endif
14385
14386 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
14387 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
14388 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
14389
14390 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
14391 }
14392
14393 \f
14394 /***********************************************************************
14395 Fonts
14396 ***********************************************************************/
14397
14398 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
14399
14400 struct font_info *
14401 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
14402 FRAME_PTR f;
14403 int font_idx;
14404 {
14405 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
14406 }
14407
14408
14409 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
14410
14411 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
14412 to be listed.
14413
14414 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
14415
14416 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
14417 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
14418 on how many fonts to match. */
14419
14420 Lisp_Object
14421 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
14422 struct frame *f;
14423 Lisp_Object pattern;
14424 int size;
14425 int maxnames;
14426 {
14427 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
14428 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
14429 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
14430 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
14431 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
14432 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
14433 int count;
14434 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
14435
14436 if (size < 0)
14437 {
14438 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
14439 size = 0;
14440 }
14441
14442 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
14443 if (NILP (patterns))
14444 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
14445
14446 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
14447 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
14448 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
14449
14450 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
14451 {
14452 int num_fonts;
14453 char **names = NULL;
14454
14455 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
14456 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
14457 The cache is an alist of the form:
14458 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
14459 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
14460 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
14461 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
14462 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
14463 if (!NILP (list))
14464 {
14465 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
14466 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
14467 goto label_cached;
14468 }
14469
14470 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
14471
14472 BLOCK_INPUT;
14473 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14474
14475 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
14476 {
14477 XFontStruct *font;
14478 unsigned long value;
14479
14480 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
14481 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14482 {
14483 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14484 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14485 font = NULL;
14486 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14487 }
14488
14489 if (font
14490 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
14491 {
14492 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
14493 int len = strlen (name);
14494 char *tmp;
14495
14496 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
14497 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
14498 string. We must avoid such a name. */
14499 if (len == 0)
14500 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
14501 else
14502 {
14503 num_fonts = 1;
14504 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
14505 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
14506 simple var. */
14507 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
14508 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
14509 XFree (name);
14510 }
14511 }
14512 else
14513 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
14514
14515 if (font)
14516 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
14517 }
14518
14519 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
14520 {
14521 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
14522 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
14523 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
14524 &num_fonts);
14525 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14526 {
14527 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14528 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14529 names = NULL;
14530 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14531 }
14532 }
14533
14534 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14536
14537 if (names)
14538 {
14539 int i;
14540
14541 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
14542 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
14543 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
14544 {
14545 int width = 0;
14546 char *p = names[i];
14547 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
14548
14549 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
14550 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
14551 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
14552 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
14553 ignore it. */
14554 while (*p)
14555 if (*p++ == '-')
14556 {
14557 dashes++;
14558 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
14559 width = atoi (p);
14560 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
14561 average_width = atoi (p);
14562 }
14563
14564 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
14565 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
14566 {
14567 tem = build_string (names[i]);
14568 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
14569 {
14570 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
14571 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
14572 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
14573 >= 0))
14574 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
14575 width of this font. */
14576 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
14577 else
14578 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
14579 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
14580 }
14581 }
14582 }
14583
14584 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
14585 {
14586 BLOCK_INPUT;
14587 XFreeFontNames (names);
14588 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14589 }
14590 }
14591
14592 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
14593 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14594 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14595
14596 label_cached:
14597 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
14598
14599 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
14600 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
14601 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
14602 {
14603 int found_size;
14604
14605 tem = XCAR (list);
14606
14607 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
14608 continue;
14609 if (!size)
14610 {
14611 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14612 continue;
14613 }
14614
14615 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
14616 {
14617 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
14618 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
14619 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
14620
14621 BLOCK_INPUT;
14622 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14623 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
14624 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
14625 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14626 {
14627 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14628 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14629 thisinfo = NULL;
14630 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14631 }
14632 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14633 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14634
14635 if (thisinfo)
14636 {
14637 XSETCDR (tem,
14638 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
14639 ? make_number (0)
14640 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
14641 BLOCK_INPUT;
14642 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
14643 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14644 }
14645 else
14646 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
14647 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
14648 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
14649 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
14650 }
14651
14652 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
14653 if (found_size == size)
14654 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14655 else if (found_size > 0)
14656 {
14657 if (NILP (second_best))
14658 second_best = tem;
14659 else if (found_size < size)
14660 {
14661 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14662 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
14663 second_best = tem;
14664 }
14665 else
14666 {
14667 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14668 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
14669 second_best = tem;
14670 }
14671 }
14672 }
14673 if (!NILP (newlist))
14674 break;
14675 else if (!NILP (second_best))
14676 {
14677 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
14678 break;
14679 }
14680 }
14681
14682 return newlist;
14683 }
14684
14685
14686 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14687
14688 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
14689 font table. */
14690
14691 static void
14692 x_check_font (f, font)
14693 struct frame *f;
14694 XFontStruct *font;
14695 {
14696 int i;
14697 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14698
14699 xassert (font != NULL);
14700
14701 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14702 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14703 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
14704 break;
14705
14706 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
14707 }
14708
14709 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
14710
14711 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
14712 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
14713 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
14714 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
14715 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
14716
14717 static INLINE void
14718 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
14719 XFontStruct *font;
14720 int *w, *h;
14721 {
14722 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14723 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
14724
14725 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
14726 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
14727 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
14728 if (*w <= 0)
14729 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
14730 }
14731
14732
14733 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
14734 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
14735 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
14736 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
14737 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
14738
14739 static int
14740 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
14741 struct frame *f;
14742 {
14743 int i;
14744 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14745 XFontStruct *font;
14746 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
14747 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
14748
14749 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
14750 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
14751
14752 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14753 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
14754 {
14755 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14756 int w, h;
14757
14758 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
14759 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
14760 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
14761
14762 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
14763 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
14764 }
14765
14766 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
14767 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
14768
14769 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
14770 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
14771 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
14772 }
14773
14774
14775 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
14776 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
14777 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
14778 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
14779
14780 struct font_info *
14781 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
14782 struct frame *f;
14783 register char *fontname;
14784 int size;
14785 {
14786 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14787 Lisp_Object font_names;
14788 int count;
14789
14790 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
14791 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
14792 we already have by comparing names. */
14793 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
14794
14795 if (!NILP (font_names))
14796 {
14797 Lisp_Object tail;
14798 int i;
14799
14800 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14801 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
14802 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14803 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
14804 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
14805 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
14806 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
14807 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
14808 }
14809
14810 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
14811 {
14812 char *full_name;
14813 XFontStruct *font;
14814 struct font_info *fontp;
14815 unsigned long value;
14816 int i;
14817
14818 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
14819 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
14820 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
14821 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
14822 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
14823 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
14824 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
14825
14826 BLOCK_INPUT;
14827 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14828 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
14829 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
14830 {
14831 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14832 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14833 font = NULL;
14834 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14835 }
14836 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
14837 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14838 if (!font)
14839 return NULL;
14840
14841 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
14842 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14843 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
14844 break;
14845
14846 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
14847 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
14848 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
14849 {
14850 int sz;
14851 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
14852 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
14853 dpyinfo->font_table
14854 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
14855 }
14856
14857 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14858 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
14859 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
14860
14861 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
14862 BLOCK_INPUT;
14863 fontp->font = font;
14864 fontp->font_idx = i;
14865 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
14866 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
14867
14868 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
14869 full_name = 0;
14870 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
14871 {
14872 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
14873 char *p = name;
14874 int dashes = 0;
14875
14876 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
14877 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
14878 so don't use it.
14879 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
14880 stored in them. */
14881 while (*p)
14882 {
14883 if (*p == '-')
14884 dashes++;
14885 p++;
14886 }
14887
14888 if (dashes >= 13)
14889 {
14890 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
14891 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
14892 }
14893
14894 XFree (name);
14895 }
14896
14897 if (full_name != 0)
14898 fontp->full_name = full_name;
14899 else
14900 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
14901
14902 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
14903 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14904
14905 if (NILP (font_names))
14906 {
14907 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
14908 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
14909 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
14910 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
14911 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
14912 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
14913 Qnil);
14914
14915 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14916 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14917 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14918 make_number (fontp->size)),
14919 Qnil)),
14920 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14921 if (full_name)
14922 {
14923 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
14924 Qnil);
14925 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14926 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14927 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14928 make_number (fontp->size)),
14929 Qnil)),
14930 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14931 }
14932 }
14933
14934 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
14935 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
14936 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
14937 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
14938 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
14939 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
14940 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
14941 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
14942 fontp->encoding[1]
14943 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
14944 /* 1-byte font */
14945 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14946 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14947 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
14948 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
14949 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
14950 /* 2-byte font */
14951 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
14952 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
14953 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14954 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14955 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
14956 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
14957 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
14958 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
14959 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14960 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14961 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
14962 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
14963 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
14964
14965 fontp->baseline_offset
14966 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
14967 ? (long) value : 0);
14968 fontp->relative_compose
14969 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
14970 ? (long) value : 0);
14971 fontp->default_ascent
14972 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
14973 ? (long) value : 0);
14974
14975 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
14976 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
14977 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
14978 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
14979 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
14980 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
14981 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14982 return fontp;
14983 }
14984 }
14985
14986
14987 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
14988 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
14989
14990 struct font_info *
14991 x_query_font (f, fontname)
14992 struct frame *f;
14993 register char *fontname;
14994 {
14995 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14996 int i;
14997
14998 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14999 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
15000 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
15001 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
15002 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
15003 return NULL;
15004 }
15005
15006
15007 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
15008 `encoder' of the structure. */
15009
15010 void
15011 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
15012 struct font_info *fontp;
15013 {
15014 Lisp_Object list, elt;
15015
15016 elt = Qnil;
15017 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
15018 {
15019 elt = XCAR (list);
15020 if (CONSP (elt)
15021 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
15022 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
15023 >= 0)
15024 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
15025 >= 0)))
15026 break;
15027 }
15028
15029 if (! NILP (list))
15030 {
15031 struct ccl_program *ccl
15032 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
15033
15034 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
15035 xfree (ccl);
15036 else
15037 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
15038 }
15039 }
15040
15041
15042 \f
15043 /***********************************************************************
15044 Initialization
15045 ***********************************************************************/
15046
15047 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
15048 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
15049 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
15050 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
15051
15052 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
15053 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
15054 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
15055
15056 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15057 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15058 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15059 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15060 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15061 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
15062 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
15063 };
15064 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
15065
15066 static int x_initialized;
15067
15068 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
15069 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
15070 the screen number from the server number. */
15071 static int
15072 same_x_server (name1, name2)
15073 const char *name1, *name2;
15074 {
15075 int seen_colon = 0;
15076 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
15077 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
15078 int length_until_period = 0;
15079
15080 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
15081 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
15082 length_until_period++;
15083
15084 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
15085 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
15086 name1 += 4;
15087 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
15088 name2 += 4;
15089 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
15090 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
15091 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
15092 name1 += system_name_length;
15093 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
15094 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
15095 name2 += system_name_length;
15096 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
15097 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
15098 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
15099 name1 += length_until_period;
15100 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
15101 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
15102 name2 += length_until_period;
15103
15104 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
15105 {
15106 if (*name1 == ':')
15107 seen_colon++;
15108 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
15109 return 1;
15110 }
15111 return (seen_colon
15112 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
15113 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
15114 }
15115 #endif
15116
15117 struct x_display_info *
15118 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
15119 Lisp_Object display_name;
15120 char *xrm_option;
15121 char *resource_name;
15122 {
15123 int connection;
15124 Display *dpy;
15125 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
15126 XrmDatabase xrdb;
15127
15128 BLOCK_INPUT;
15129
15130 if (!x_initialized)
15131 {
15132 x_initialize ();
15133 x_initialized = 1;
15134 }
15135
15136 #ifdef USE_GTK
15137 {
15138 #define NUM_ARGV 10
15139 int argc;
15140 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
15141 char **argv2 = argv;
15142 GdkAtom atom;
15143
15144 /* GTK 2.0 can only handle one display, GTK 2.2 can handle more
15145 than one, but this remains to be implemented. */
15146 if (x_initialized > 1)
15147 return 0;
15148
15149 x_initialized++;
15150
15151 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
15152 argv[argc] = 0;
15153
15154 argc = 0;
15155 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
15156
15157 if (! NILP (display_name))
15158 {
15159 argv[argc++] = "--display";
15160 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
15161 }
15162
15163 argv[argc++] = "--name";
15164 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
15165
15166 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
15167
15168 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
15169 fixup_locale ();
15170 xg_initialize ();
15171
15172 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
15173
15174 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
15175 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
15176
15177 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
15178 {
15179 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
15180 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
15181 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
15182
15183 GCPRO2 (str, abs_file);
15184 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
15185 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name(s, Qnil);
15186
15187 if (! NILP (abs_file) && Ffile_readable_p (abs_file))
15188 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
15189
15190 UNGCPRO;
15191 }
15192
15193 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
15194 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
15195 }
15196 #else /* not USE_GTK */
15197 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
15198 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
15199 errors with X11R5:
15200 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
15201 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
15202 So let's not use it until R6. */
15203 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
15204 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
15205 #endif
15206
15207 {
15208 int argc = 0;
15209 char *argv[3];
15210
15211 argv[0] = "";
15212 argc = 1;
15213 if (xrm_option)
15214 {
15215 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
15216 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
15217 }
15218 turn_on_atimers (0);
15219 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
15220 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
15221 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
15222 &argc, argv);
15223 turn_on_atimers (1);
15224
15225 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
15226 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
15227 fixup_locale ();
15228 #endif
15229 }
15230
15231 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
15232 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
15233 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
15234 #endif
15235 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
15236 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
15237 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
15238
15239 /* Detect failure. */
15240 if (dpy == 0)
15241 {
15242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
15243 return 0;
15244 }
15245
15246 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
15247
15248 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
15249 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
15250
15251 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
15252 {
15253 struct x_display_info *share;
15254 Lisp_Object tail;
15255
15256 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
15257 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
15258 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
15259 SDATA (display_name)))
15260 break;
15261 if (share)
15262 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
15263 else
15264 {
15265 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
15266 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
15267 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
15268 {
15269 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
15270 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
15271 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
15272 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
15273 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
15274 BLOCK_INPUT;
15275 }
15276
15277 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
15278 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
15279 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
15280 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
15281 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
15282 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
15283 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
15284 }
15285 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
15286 }
15287 #endif
15288
15289 /* Put this display on the chain. */
15290 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
15291 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
15292
15293 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
15294 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
15295 x_display_name_list);
15296 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
15297
15298 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
15299
15300 #if 0
15301 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
15302 #endif /* ! 0 */
15303
15304 dpyinfo->x_id_name
15305 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
15306 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
15307 + 2);
15308 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
15309 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
15310
15311 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
15312 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
15313
15314 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
15315 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
15316 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
15317
15318 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
15319 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
15320 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
15321 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
15322 #else
15323 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
15324 #endif
15325 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
15326 all versions. */
15327 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
15328
15329 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
15330 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
15331 select_visual (dpyinfo);
15332 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
15333 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
15334 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
15335 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
15336 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
15337 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
15338 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
15339 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
15340 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
15341 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
15342 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
15343 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
15344 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
15345 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
15346 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
15347 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
15348 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
15349 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
15350 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
15351 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
15352 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
15353 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
15354 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
15355 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
15356 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
15357 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
15358 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
15359 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
15360
15361 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
15362 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
15363 {
15364 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
15365 {
15366 Lisp_Object value;
15367 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
15368 build_string ("privateColormap"),
15369 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
15370 Qnil, Qnil);
15371 if (STRINGP (value)
15372 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
15373 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
15374 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
15375 }
15376 }
15377 else
15378 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
15379 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
15380
15381 {
15382 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
15383 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
15384 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
15385 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
15386 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
15387 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
15388 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
15389 }
15390
15391 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
15392 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
15393 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
15394 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
15395 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
15396 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
15397 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
15398 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
15399 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
15400 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
15401 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
15402 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
15403 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
15404 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
15405 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
15406 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
15407 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
15408 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
15409 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
15410 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
15411 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
15412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
15413 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
15414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
15415 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
15416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
15417 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
15418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
15419 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
15420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
15421 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
15422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
15423 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
15424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
15425 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
15426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
15427 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
15428 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
15429 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
15430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
15431 /* For properties of font. */
15432 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
15433 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
15434 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
15435 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
15436 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
15437 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
15438 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
15439 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
15440
15441 /* Ghostscript support. */
15442 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
15443 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
15444
15445 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
15446 False);
15447
15448 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
15449
15450 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
15451 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
15452
15453 {
15454 char null_bits[1];
15455
15456 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
15457
15458 dpyinfo->null_pixel
15459 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
15460 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
15461 1);
15462 }
15463
15464 {
15465 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
15466 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
15467 dpyinfo->gray
15468 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
15469 gray_bitmap_bits,
15470 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
15471 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
15472 }
15473
15474 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
15475 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
15476 #endif
15477
15478 #ifdef subprocesses
15479 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
15480 if (connection != 0)
15481 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
15482 #endif
15483
15484 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
15485 #ifdef F_SETOWN
15486 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
15487 /* stdin is a socket here */
15488 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
15489 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
15490 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
15491 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
15492 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
15493 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
15494
15495 #ifdef SIGIO
15496 if (interrupt_input)
15497 init_sigio (connection);
15498 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
15499
15500 #ifdef USE_LUCID
15501 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
15502 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
15503 so that Xt does not crash. */
15504 {
15505 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
15506 XrmValue d, fr, to;
15507 Font font;
15508 int count;
15509
15510 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
15511 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
15512 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
15513 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
15514 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
15515 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
15516 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
15517 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
15518 abort ();
15519 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
15520 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
15521 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
15522 }
15523 #endif
15524 #endif
15525
15526 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
15527 for debugging X code. */
15528 {
15529 Lisp_Object value;
15530 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
15531 build_string ("synchronous"),
15532 build_string ("Synchronous"),
15533 Qnil, Qnil);
15534 if (STRINGP (value)
15535 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
15536 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
15537 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
15538 }
15539
15540 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
15541
15542 return dpyinfo;
15543 }
15544 \f
15545 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
15546 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
15547
15548 void
15549 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
15550 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
15551 {
15552 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
15553
15554 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
15555 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
15556 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
15557 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
15558 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
15559 else
15560 {
15561 Lisp_Object tail;
15562
15563 tail = x_display_name_list;
15564 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
15565 {
15566 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
15567 {
15568 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
15569 break;
15570 }
15571 tail = XCDR (tail);
15572 }
15573 }
15574
15575 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
15576 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
15577
15578 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
15579 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
15580 else
15581 {
15582 struct x_display_info *tail;
15583
15584 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
15585 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
15586 tail->next = tail->next->next;
15587 }
15588
15589 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
15590 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
15591 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
15592 #endif
15593 #endif
15594 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
15595 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
15596 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
15597 #endif
15598 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
15599 if (dpyinfo->xim)
15600 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
15601 #endif
15602
15603 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
15604 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
15605 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
15606 xfree (dpyinfo);
15607 }
15608
15609 \f
15610 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
15611
15612 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
15613 {
15614 x_produce_glyphs,
15615 x_write_glyphs,
15616 x_insert_glyphs,
15617 x_clear_end_of_line,
15618 x_scroll_run,
15619 x_after_update_window_line,
15620 x_update_window_begin,
15621 x_update_window_end,
15622 XTcursor_to,
15623 x_flush,
15624 x_clear_mouse_face,
15625 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
15626 x_fix_overlapping_area
15627 };
15628
15629 void
15630 x_initialize ()
15631 {
15632 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
15633
15634 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
15635 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
15636 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
15637 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
15638 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
15639 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
15640 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
15641 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
15642 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
15643 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
15644 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
15645 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
15646 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
15647 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
15648 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
15649 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
15650 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
15651 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
15652 estimate_mode_line_height_hook = x_estimate_mode_line_height;
15653
15654 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
15655 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
15656 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
15657 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
15658 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
15659 off the bottom */
15660 baud_rate = 19200;
15661
15662 x_noop_count = 0;
15663 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
15664 any_help_event_p = 0;
15665
15666 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
15667 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
15668
15669 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
15670 XtToolkitInitialize ();
15671
15672 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
15673
15674 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
15675 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
15676 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
15677 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
15678 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
15679 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
15680 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
15681
15682 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
15683
15684 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
15685 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
15686 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
15687 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
15688 widgets don't behave normally. */
15689 {
15690 EMACS_TIME interval;
15691 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
15692 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
15693 }
15694 #endif
15695
15696 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15697 #ifndef USE_GTK
15698 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
15699 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
15700 #endif
15701 #endif
15702
15703 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
15704 original error handler. */
15705 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
15706 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
15707
15708 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
15709 #ifdef SIGWINCH
15710 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
15711 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
15712
15713 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
15714
15715 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
15716 x_session_initialize ();
15717 #endif
15718 }
15719
15720
15721 void
15722 syms_of_xterm ()
15723 {
15724 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
15725 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
15726
15727 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
15728 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
15729
15730 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
15731 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
15732
15733 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
15734 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
15735
15736 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
15737 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
15738 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
15739 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
15740
15741 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
15742 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
15743
15744 help_echo = Qnil;
15745 staticpro (&help_echo);
15746 help_echo_object = Qnil;
15747 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
15748 help_echo_window = Qnil;
15749 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
15750 previous_help_echo = Qnil;
15751 staticpro (&previous_help_echo);
15752 help_echo_pos = -1;
15753
15754 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mouse-autoselect-window", &mouse_autoselect_window,
15755 doc: /* *Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer. */);
15756 mouse_autoselect_window = 0;
15757
15758 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", &x_stretch_cursor_p,
15759 doc: /* *Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
15760 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
15761 wide as that tab on the display. */);
15762 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
15763
15764 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
15765 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
15766 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
15767 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
15768 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
15769 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
15770 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
15771
15772 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
15773 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
15774 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
15775 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
15776 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15777 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
15778 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
15779 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
15780 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
15781 #elif USE_GTK
15782 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
15783 #else
15784 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
15785 #endif
15786 #else
15787 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
15788 #endif
15789
15790 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
15791 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
15792
15793 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
15794 Qalt = intern ("alt");
15795 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
15796 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
15797 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
15798 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
15799 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
15800 Qsuper = intern ("super");
15801 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
15802
15803 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
15804 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
15805 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15806 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
15807 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
15808 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
15809
15810 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
15811 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
15812 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15813 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
15814 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
15815 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
15816
15817 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
15818 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
15819 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15820 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
15821 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
15822 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
15823
15824 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
15825 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
15826 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15827 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
15828 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
15829 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
15830
15831 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
15832 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
15833 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
15834 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
15835 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
15836 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
15837 }
15838
15839 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */